  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
1
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Highest-Performance Fixed-Point Digital
Signal Processors (DSPs)
− 2-, 1.67-, 1.39-ns Instruction Cycle Time
− 500-, 600-, 720-MHz Clock Rate
− Eight 32-Bit Instructions/Cycle
− Twenty-Eight Operations/Cycle
− 4000, 4800, 5760 MIPS
− Fully Software-Compatible With C62x
− C6414/15/16 Devices Pin-Compatible
VelociTI.2 Extensions to VelociTI
Advanced Very-Long-Instruction-Word
(VLIW) TMS320C64x DSP Core
− Eight Highly Independent Functional
Units With VelociTI.2 Extensions:
− Six ALUs (32-/40-Bit), Each Supports
Single 32-Bit, Dual 16-Bit, or Quad
8-Bit Arithmetic per Clock Cycle
− Two Multipliers Support
Four 16 x 16-Bit Multiplies
(32-Bit Results) per Clock Cycle or
Eight 8 x 8-Bit Multiplies
(16-Bit Results) per Clock Cycle
− Non-Aligned Load-Store Architecture
− 64 32-Bit General-Purpose Registers
− Instruction Packing Reduces Code Size
− All Instructions Conditional
Instruction Set Features
− Byte-Addressable (8-/16-/32-/64-Bit Data)
− 8-Bit Overflow Protection
− Bit-Field Extract, Set, Clear
− Normalization, Saturation, Bit-Counting
− VelociTI.2 Increased Orthogonality
Viterbi Decoder Coprocessor (VCP) [C6416]
− Supports Over 600 7.95-Kbps AMR
− Programmable Code Parameters
Turbo Decoder Coprocessor (TCP) [C6416]
− Supports up to 7 2-Mbps or
43 384-Kbps 3GPP (6 Iterations)
− Programmable Turbo Code and
Decoding Parameters
L1/L2 Memory Architecture
− 128K-Bit (16K-Byte) L1P Program Cache
(Direct Mapped)
− 128K-Bit (16K-Byte) L1D Data Cache
(2-Way Set-Associative)
− 8M-Bit (1024K-Byte) L2 Unified Mapped
RAM/Cache (Flexible Allocation)
Two External Memory Interfaces (EMIFs)
− One 64-Bit (EMIFA), One 16-Bit (EMIFB)
− Glueless Interface to Asynchronous
Memories (SRAM and EPROM) and
Synchronous Memories (SDRAM,
SBSRAM, ZBT SRAM, and FIFO)
− 1280M-Byte Total Addressable External
Memory Space
Enhanced Direct-Memory-Access (EDMA)
Controller (64 Independent Channels)
Host-Port Interface (HPI)
− User-Configurable Bus Width (32-/16-Bit)
32-Bit/33-MHz, 3.3-V PCI Master/Slave
Interface Conforms to PCI Specification 2.2
[C6415/C6416 ]
− Three PCI Bus Address Registers:
Prefetchable Memory
Non-Prefetchable Memory I/O
− Four-Wire Serial EEPROM Interface
− PCI Interrupt Request Under DSP
Program Control
− DSP Interrupt Via PCI I/O Cycle
Three Multichannel Buffered Serial Ports
− Direct Interface to T1/E1, MVIP, SCSA
Framers
− Up to 256 Channels Each
− ST-Bus-Switching-, AC97-Compatible
− Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
Compatible (Motorola)
Three 32-Bit General-Purpose Timers
Universal Test and Operations PHY
Interface for ATM (UTOPIA) [C6415/C6416]
− UTOPIA Level 2 Slave ATM Controller
− 8-Bit Transmit and Receive Operations
up to 50 MHz per Direction
− User-Defined Cell Format up to 64 Bytes
Sixteen General-Purpose I/O (GPIO) Pins
Flexible PLL Clock Generator
IEEE-1149.1 (JTAG)
Boundary-Scan-Compatible
532-Pin Ball Grid Array (BGA) Package
(GLZ and ZLZ Suffix), 0.8-mm Ball Pitch
0.13-µm/6-Level Cu Metal Process (CMOS)
3.3-V I/Os, 1.2-V/1.25-V Internal (500 MHz)
3.3-V I/Os, 1.4-V Internal (600 and 720 MHz)
ADVANCE INFORMATION
Please be aware that an important notice concerning availability, standard warranty, and use in critical applications o
f
Texas Instruments semiconductor products and disclaimers thereto appears at the end of this data sheet.
 !"#$% $%&$ $'("&%$ $ )(!% $ "(# %&$ $# )&#
' #*#+)"#$%, # %&%! ' #& #*#  $&%# $ %# )&-#./
)#'0$- % #+#%(&+ &(&%#(%,
Copyright 2004 Texas Instruments Incorporated
C62x, VelociTI.2, VelociTI, and TMS320C64x are trademarks of Texas Instruments.
Motorola is a trademark of Motorola, Inc.
IEEE Standard 1149.1-1990 Standard-Test-Access Port and Boundary Scan Architecture.
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
2POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Table of Contents
reset 78. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
absolute maximum ratings over operating case
temperature range 79. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
recommended operating conditions 79. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
electrical characteristics over recommended ranges of
supply voltage and operating case temperature 80.
recommended clock and control signal transition
behavior 80. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
parameter measurement information 81. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
input and output clocks 83. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
asynchronous memory timing 87. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
programmable synchronous interface timing 91. . . . . . . .
synchronous DRAM timing 96. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
HOLD/HOLDA timing 106. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
BUSREQ timing 107. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
reset timing 108. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
external interrupt timing 110. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
host-port interface (HPI) timing 111. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
peripheral component interconnect (PCI) timing
[C6415 and C6416 only] 116. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
multichannel buffered serial port (McBSP) timing 119. . . .
UTOPIA slave timing [C6415 and C6416 only] 130. . . . . .
timer timing 133. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
general-purpose input/output (GPIO) port timing 134. . . .
JTAG test-port timing 135. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
mechanical data 136. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
revision history 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
GLZ and ZLZ BGA packages (bottom view) 6. . . . . . . . . . . . .
description 7. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
device characteristics 8. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
device compatibility 9. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
functional block and CPU (DSP core) diagram 10. . . . . . . . . .
CPU (DSP core) description 11. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
memory map summary 14. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
peripheral register descriptions 17. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EDMA channel synchronization events 30. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
interrupt sources and interrupt selector 32. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
signal groups description 34. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
device configurations 39. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
multiplexed pins 43. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
debugging considerations 43. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
terminal functions 45. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
development support 65. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
device support 66. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
clock PLL 69. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
general-purpose input/output (GPIO) 72. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
power-down mode logic 73. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
power-supply sequencing 75. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
power-supply decoupling 76. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
IEEE 1149.1 JTAG compatibility statement 77. . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMIF device speed 77. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
bootmode 78. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
REVISION HISTORY
This data sheet revision history highlights the technical changes made to the SPRS146K device-specific data
sheet to make it an SPRS146L revision.
Scope: Applicable updates to the C64x device family, specifically relating to the C6414, C6415, and C6416
devices, have been incorporated. Added C6414, C6415, and C6416 silicon revision 2.0 devices and associated
device-specific information at the production data (PD) stage of development.
The extended temperature devices for silicon revision 2.0 (C641x A-5E0, C641xA-6E3) are at the advance infor-
mation (AI) stage of development. All other devices are at the Production Data (PD) stage of development.
PAGE(S)
NO. ADDITIONS/CHANGES/DELETIONS
1 Features:
Changed the Viterbi Decoder Coprocessor (VCP) [C6416] sub-bullet from “Supports Over 500 7.95-Kbps AMR” to
“Supports Over 600 7.95-Kbps AMR”
Changed the Turbo Decoder Coprocessor (TCP) [C6416] sub-bullet from “Supports up to Six 2-Mbps 3GPP (6 Iterations)”
to “Supports up to 7 2-Mbps or 43 384-Kbps 3GPP (6 Iterations)”
7Description section:
“With performance of up to 5760 million instructions per second (MIPS) ...” paragraph
Changed “The C64x can produce four 32-bit multiply-accumulates (MACs) per ...” sentence to “The C64x can produce four
16-bit multiply-accumulates (MACs) per ...”
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
3
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
PAGE(S)
NO. ADDITIONS/CHANGES/DELETIONS
7Description section:
“The C6416 device has two high-performance embedded coprocessors [Viterbi Decoder Coprocessor (VCP) and Turbo
Decoder Coprocessor (TCP)] that ...” paragraph
Changed “The VCP operating at CPU clock divided-by-4 can decode over 500 7.95-Kbps adaptive multi-rate ...” sentence to
“The VCP operating at CPU clock divided-by-4 can decode over 600 7.95-Kbps adaptive multi-rate ...”
Changed “The TCP operating at CPU clock divided-by-2 can decode up to thirty-six 384-Kbps or six 2-Mbps turbo encoded
channels ...” sentence to “The TCP operating at CPU clock divided-by-2 can decode up to forty-three 384-Kbps or seven
2-Mbps turbo encoded channels ...”
16 L2 architecture expanded section:
Added new section
Added Figure 2, TMS320C6414/C6415/C6416 L2 Architecture Memory Configuration
18 Peripheral register descriptions section:
Table 6, L2 Cache Registers:
Updated the “ACRONYM” and “REGISTER NAME” columns for the “0184 4000 through 0184 5004” HEX ADDRESS
RANGE
Added rows “0184 4018” and “0184 401C”
Changed the “0184 4038 − 0184 4FFC” HEX ADDRESS RANGE for the “Reserved” row to “0184 4038 − 0184 4044”
Added rows “0184 4048” and “0184 404C”
Added “Reserved” row “0184 4050 − 0184 4FFC”
22 Peripheral register descriptions section:
EDMA Parameter RAM table:
Updated associated table footnote from “The C64x device ...” to “The C6414/C6415/C6416 device ...”
66 Added “device support” section title (new)
66−67 Device and development-support tool nomenclature section:
Updated/changed “Table 30 displays the device part numbers and ordering information for ...” paragraph
Deleted Table 30, TMS320C6414/C6415/C6416 Device Part Numbers (P/Ns) and Ordering Information
Deleted the “TMX and TMP devices and TMDX development-support tools are shipped with ...” paragraph
Figure 5, TMS320C64x DSP Device Nomenclature (Including the C6414, C6415, and C6416 Devices):
Updated/changed the “For the actual device part numbers (P/Ns) and ordering information, ...” footnote
Added, below Figure 5, “For additional information, see the TMS320C6414, TMS320C6415, and TMS320C6416 Digital
Signal Processors Silicon Errata (literature number SPRZ011)” paragraph (new)
68 Documentation support section:
Updated/moved the “How To Begin Development Today With the TMS320C6414, TMS320C6415, and TMS320C6416 DSPs
application report (literature number SPRA718)” document reference
76 Power-supply decoupling section:
Updated/changed the “In order to properly decouple the supply planes from system noise, place as many capacitors ...”
paragraph
Added two subsequent paragraphs
78 Reset section:
Added new section
77 IEEE 1149.1 JTAG compatibility statement section:
Updated/added paragraphs for clarity
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
4POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
PAGE(S)
NO. ADDITIONS/CHANGES/DELETIONS
87−88 Asynchronous Memory Timing section:
Timing Requirements for Asynchronous Memory Cycles for EMIFA Module table:
Added/split silicon revisions “Rev 1.1 and earlier” and “Rev 2.0” for the MIN value of parameter #7 “th(EKO1H-ARDY), Hold
time, ARDY valid after ECLKOUTx high”
Added under the “−5E0, −6E3, −7E3” column, the MIN value of “1.3” ns for “Rev 2.0”
Timing Requirements for Asynchronous Memory Cycles for EMIFB Module table:
Added/split silicon revisions “Rev 1.1 and earlier” and “Rev 2.0” for the MIN value of parameter #7 “th(EKO1H-ARDY), Hold
time, ARDY valid after ECLKOUTx high”
Added under the “−5E0, −6E3, −7E3” column, the MIN value of “1.3” ns for “Rev 2.0”
106 HOLD/HOLDA Timing section:
Timing Requirements for the HOLD/HOLDA Cycles for EMIFA and EMIFB modules table:
Changed parameter NO. 3 from “toh(HOLDAL-HOLDL)to “th(HOLDAL-HOLDL)
108 Reset Timing section:
Timing Requirements for Reset table:
Changed the MIN value of parameter No. 16, tsu(boot) from “4P” to “4E or 4C” ns
Added associated footnote to identify “E” and “C”
Added parameter NO. 18, “td(PCLK−RSTH) Delay time, PCLK active to RESET high” with a MIN value of “32N” ns
Changed pa rameter NO. 18 description from “td(PCLK−RSTH) Delay time, PCLK active to RESET high” to “tsu(PCLK-RSTH),
Setup time, PCLK active before RESET high”
Added associated footnote to identify “N” and restraints
Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions During Reset table:
Moved parameter NO. 18, “td(PCLK−RSTH) Delay time, PCLK active to RESET high” to the Timing Requirements for Reset
table
Updated footnote symbols
111 Host-Port Interface (HPI) Timing section:
Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions During Host-Port Interface Cycles table:
Added “mode, 2nd half-word” to parameter NO. 16 “td(HSTBL-HDV), Delay time, HSTROBE low to HD valid (HPI16 only)”
118 Peripheral Component Interconnect (PCI) Timing [C6415 AND C6416 ONLY] section:
Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for Serial EEPROM Interface table:
Changed parameter NO. 6 description from “tosu(DOV-CLKH), Output setup time, XSP_DO valid after XSP_CLK high” to
“tosu(DOV-CLKH), Output setup time, XSP_DO valid before XSP_CLK high”
120−121 Multichannel Buffered Serial Port (McBSP) Timing section:
Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for McBSP table:
Changed the MIN value of parameter #12 “tdis(CKXH-DXHZ), Disable time, DX high impedance following last data bit from
CLKX high, CLKX ext from2.1” to “2.0” ns
Changed the MIN value of parameter #13 “td(CKXH-DXV), Delay time, CLKX high to DX valid, CLKX ext from2.1 + D1” to
“2.0 + D1” ns
Changed the MIN value of parameter #14 “td(FXH-DXV), Delay time, FSX high to DX valid, FSX int from “−2.3” to
“−2.3 + D1” ns
Changed the MAX value of parameter #14 “td(FXH-DXV), Delay time, FSX high to DX valid, FSX int from “5.6” to
“5.6 + D2” ns
Changed the MIN value of parameter #14 “td(FXH-DXV), Delay time, FSX high to DX valid, FSX ext from “1.9” to
“1.9 + D1” ns
Changed the MAX value of parameter #14 “td(FXH-DXV), Delay time, FSX high to DX valid, FSX ext from “9” to “9 + D2” ns
Added associated footnote
Figure 51, McBSP Timing:
Added footnote for clarity
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
5
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
PAGE(S)
NO. ADDITIONS/CHANGES/DELETIONS
134 General-Purpose Input/Output (GPIO) Port Timing section:
Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for GPIO Outputs table:
Changed the MIN value of parameter #3 “tw(GPOH), Pulse duration, GPOx high” from “32P” to “24P − 8” ns
Changed the MIN value of parameter #4 “tw(GPOL), Pulse duration, GPOx low” from “32P” to “24P − 8” ns
Added associated footnote
136 Mechanical Data section:
Deleted the “GLZ and ZLZ (S-PBGA-N532), PLASTIC BALL GRID ARRAY” mechanical data package diagram; now an
automated merged process
Added the “thermal resistance characteristics (S-PBGA package) [ZLZ]” table
Added lead-in sentence for the thermal resistance characteristics table(s) and the “merged” mechanical data packages
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
6POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
GLZ and ZLZ BGA packages (bottom view)
GLZ and ZLZ 532-PIN BALL GRID ARRAY (BGA) PACKAGE
(BOTTOM VIEW)
A
2
B
1 3 456789101112
1314
151617181920212223242526
C
DE
FG
HJ
KL
MN
PR
TU
VW
YAA
AB AC
AD AE
AF
The ZLZ mechanical package designator represents the version of the GLZ package with lead-free balls. For more detailed informatio
n,
see the Mechanical Data section of this document.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
7
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
description
The TMS320C64x DSPs (including the TMS320C6414, TMS320C6415, and TMS320C6416 devices) are the
highest-performance fixed-point DSP generation in the TMS320C6000 DSP platform. The TMS320C64x
(C64x) device is based on the second-generation high-performance, advanced VelociTI
very-long-instruction-word (VLIW) architecture (VelociTI.2) developed by Texas Instruments (TI), making
these DSPs an excellent choice for multichannel and multifunction applications. The C64x is a
code-compatible member of the C6000 DSP platform.
With performance of up to 5760 million instructions per second (MIPS) at a clock rate of 720 MHz, the C64x
devices offer cost-effective solutions to high-performance DSP programming challenges. The C64x DSPs
possess the operational flexibility of high-speed controllers and the numerical capability of array processors.
The C64x DSP core processor has 64 general-purpose registers of 32-bit word length and eight highly
independent functional units—two multipliers for a 32-bit result and six arithmetic logic units (ALUs)— with
VelociTI.2 extensions. The VelociTI.2 extensions in the eight functional units include new instructions to
accelerate the performance in key applications and extend the parallelism of the VelociTI architecture. The
C64x can produce four 16-bit multiply-accumulates (MACs) per cycle for a total of 2880 million MACs per
second (MMACS), or eight 8-bit MACs per cycle for a total of 5760 MMACS. The C64x DSP also has
application-specific hardware logic, on-chip memory, and additional on-chip peripherals similar to the other
C6000 DSP platform devices.
The C6416 device has two high-performance embedded coprocessors [Viterbi Decoder Coprocessor (VCP)
and Turbo Decoder Coprocessor (TCP)] that significantly speed up channel-decoding operations on-chip. The
VCP operating at CPU clock divided-by-4 can decode over 600 7.95-Kbps adaptive multi-rate (AMR) [K = 9,
R = 1/3] voice channels. The VCP supports constraint lengths K = 5, 6, 7, 8, and 9, rates R = 1/2, 1/3, and 1/4,
and flexible polynomials, while generating hard decisions or soft decisions. The TCP operating at CPU clock
divided-by-2 can decode up to forty-three 384-Kbps or seven 2-Mbps turbo encoded channels (assuming 6
iterations). The TCP implements the max*log-map algorithm and is designed to support all polynomials and
rates required by Third-Generation Partnership Projects (3GPP and 3GPP2), with fully programmable frame
length and turbo interleaver. Decoding parameters such as the number of iterations and stopping criteria are
also programmable. Communications between the VCP/TCP and the CPU are carried out through the EDMA
controller.
The C64x uses a two-level cache-based architecture and has a powerful and diverse set of peripherals. The
Level 1 program cache (L1P) is a 128-Kbit direct mapped cache and the Level 1 data cache (L1D) is a 128-Kbit
2-way set-associative cache. The Level 2 memory/cache (L2) consists of an 8-Mbit memory space that is
shared between program and data space. L2 memory can be configured as mapped memory or combinations
of cache (up to 256K bytes) and mapped memory. The peripheral set includes three multichannel buffered serial
ports (McBSPs); an 8-bit Universal Test and Operations PHY Interface for Asynchronous Transfer Mode ( ATM)
Slave [ U T OPIA Slave] port (C6415/C6416 only); three 32-bit general-purpose timers; a user-configurable 16-bit
or 32-bit host-port interface (HPI16/HPI32); a peripheral component interconnect (PCI) [C6415/C6416 only];
a general-purpose input/output port (GPIO) with 16 GPIO pins; and two glueless external memory interfaces
(64-bit EMIFA and 16-bit EMIFB), both of which are capable of interfacing to synchronous and asynchronous
memories and peripherals.
The C64x has a complete set of development tools which includes: an advanced C compiler with C64x-specific
enhancements, an assembly optimizer to simplify programming and scheduling, and a Windows debugger
interface for visibility into source code execution.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
TMS320C6000, C64x, and C6000 are trademarks of Texas Instruments.
Windows is a registered trademark of the Microsoft Corporation.
All trademarks are the property of their respective owners.
Throughout the remainder of this document, the TMS320C6414, TMS320C6415, and TMS320C6416 shall be referred to as TMS320C64x or
C64x where generic, and where specific, their individual full device part numbers will be used or abbreviated as C6414, C6415, or C6416.
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (64-bit EMIFA and 16-bit EMIFB). The prefix “A” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIF A signal
whereas a prefix “B” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFB signal. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of
discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted from the signal name.
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
8POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
device characteristics
Table 1 provides an overview of the C6414, C6415, and C6416 DSPs. The table shows significant features of
the C64x devices, including the capacity of on-chip RAM, the peripherals, the CPU frequency, and the package
type with pin count.
Table 1. Characteristics of the C6414, C6415, and C6416 Processors
HARDWARE FEATURES C6414, C6415, AND C6416
EMIFA (64-bit bus width)
(default clock source = AECLKIN) 1
Peripherals EMIFB (16-bit bus width)
(default clock source = BECLKIN) 1
Not all peripherals pins
are available at the
EDMA (64 independent channels) 1
are available at the
same time. (For more
HPI (32- or 16-bit user selectable) 1 (HPI16 or HPI32)
same time. (For more
details, see the Device
Configuration section.)
PCI (32-bit) [DeviceID Register value 0xA106] 1 [C6415/C6416 only]
details, see the Device
Configuration section.)
Peripheral performance
McBSPs (default internal clock source =
CPU/4 clock frequency) 3
Peripheral performance
is dependent on
UTOPIA (8-bit mode) 1 [C6415/C6416 only]
is dependent on
chip-level configuration. 32-Bit Timers (default internal clock source =
CPU/8 clock frequency) 3
General-Purpose Input/Output 0 (GP0) 16
Decoder Coprocessors
VCP 1 (C6416 only)
Decoder Coprocessors TCP 1 (C6416 only)
Size (Bytes) 1056K
On-Chip Memory Organization 16K-Byte (16KB) L1 Program (L1P) Cache
16KB L1 Data (L1D) Cache
1024KB Unified Mapped RAM/Cache (L2)
CPU ID + CPU Rev ID Control Status Register (CSR.[31:16]) 0x0C01
Device_ID Silicon Revision Identification Register
(DEVICE_REV [19:16])
Address: 0x01B0 0200
DEVICE_REV[19:16] Silicon Revision
1111 1.03 or earlier
0001 1.03
0010 or 0000 1.1
0011 2.0
Frequency MHz 500, 600, 720
Cycle Time ns
2 ns (C6414-5E0, C6415-5E0, C6416-5E0) and
(C6414A-5E0, C6415A-5E0, C6416A-5E0)
[500-MHz CPU, 100-MHz EMIF]
1.67 ns (C6414-6E3, C6415-6E3, C6416-6E3) and
(C6414A-6E3, C6415A-6E3, C6416A-6E3)
[600-MHz CPU, 133-MHz EMIFA]
1.39 ns (C6414-7E3, C6415-7E3, C6416-7E3)
[720-MHz CPU, 133-MHz EMIFA]
Voltage Core (V) 1.2 V (-5E0)
1.25 V (A-5E0)
1.4 V (-6E3, A-6E3, -7E3)
I/O (V) 3.3 V
PLL Options CLKIN frequency multiplier Bypass (x1), x6, x12
BGA Package 23 x 23 mm 532-Pin BGA (GLZ and ZLZ)
Process Technology µm0.13 µm
Product Status Product Preview (PP), Advance Information
(AI), Production Data (PD) PD, AI
On these C64x devices, the rated EMIF speed affects only the SDRAM interface on EMIFA. For more detailed information, see the EMIF
Device Speed section of this data sheet.
The extended temperature devices for silicon revision 2.0 (C641x A-5E0, C641xA-6E3) are at the advance information (AI) stage of
development. All other devices are at the Production Data (PD) stage of development.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
9
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
device compatibility
The C64x generation of devices has a diverse and powerful set of peripherals. The common peripheral set
and pin-compatibility that the C6414, C6415, and C6416 devices offer lead to easier system designs and faster
time t o market. Table 2 identifies the peripherals and coprocessors that are available on the C6414, C6415, and
C6416 devices.
The C6414, C6415, and C6416 devices are pin-for-pin compatible, provided the following conditions are met:
All devices are using the same peripherals.
The C6414 is pin-for-pin compatible with the C6415/C6416 when the PCI and UTOPIA peripherals on the
C6415/C6416 are disabled.
The C6415 is pin-for-pin compatible with the C6416 when they are in the same peripheral selection mode.
[For more information on peripheral selection, see the Device Configurations section of this data sheet.]
The BEA[9:7] pins are properly pulled up/down.
[For more details on the device-specific BEA[9:7] pin configurations, see the Terminal Functions table of
this data sheet.]
Table 2. Peripherals and Coprocessors Available on the C6414, C6415, and C6416 Devices†‡
PERIPHERALS/COPROCESSORS C6414 C6415 C6416
EMIFA (64-bit bus width)
EMIFB (16-bit bus width)
EDMA (64 independent channels)
HPI (32- or 16-bit user selectable)
PCI (32-bit) [Specification v2.2]
McBSPs (McBSP0, McBSP1, McBSP2)
UTOPIA (8-bit mode) [Specification v1.0]
Timers (32-bit) [TIMER0, TIMER1, TIMER2]
GPIOs (GP[15:0])
VCP/TCP Coprocessors
— denotes peripheral/coprocessor is not available on this device.
Not all peripherals pins are available at the same time. (For more details, see the Device Configuration section.)
For more detailed information on the device compatibility and similarities/differences among the C6414, C6415,
and C6416 devices, see the How To Begin Development Today With the TMS320C6414, TMS320C6415, and
TMS320C6416 DSPs application report (literature number SPRA718).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
10 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
functional block and CPU (DSP core) diagram
EMIF B
16
64
Test
C64x DSP Core
Data Path B
B Register File
B31−B16
B15−B0
Instruction Fetch
Instruction Dispatch
Advanced Instruction Packet
Instruction Decode
Data Path A
A Register File
A31−A16
A15−A0
Power-Down
Logic
.L1 .S1 .M1 .D1 .D2 .M2 .S2 .L2
SDRAM
FIFO
SBSRAM
SRAM
L1P Cache
Direct-Mapped
16K Bytes Total
Control
Registers
Control
Logic
L1D Cache
2-Way Set-Associative
16K Bytes Total
Advanced
In-Circuit
Emulation
Interrupt
Control
McBSPs:
Framing Chips:
H.100, MVIP,
SCSA, T1, E1
AC97 Devices,
SPI Devices,
Codecs
C64x Digital Signal Processor
Enhanced
DMA
Controller
(64-channel)
32
L2
Memory
1024K
Bytes
PLL
(x1, x6, x12)
Timer 2
EMIF A
McBSP1
McBSP0
HPI
ZBT SRAM
Timer 1
Timer 0
McBSP2
Boot Configuration
Interrupt
Selector
16
ROM/FLASH
I/O Devices
PCI
or
GPIO[8:0]
UTOPIA
or
GPIO[15:9]
UTOPIA:
Up to 400 Mbps
Master ATMC
VCP and TCP decoder coprocessors are applicable to the C6416 device only.
For the C6415 and C6416 devices, the UTOPIA peripheral is muxed with McBSP1, and the PCI peripheral is muxed with the HPI
peripheral and the GPIO[15:9] port. For more details on the multiplexed pins of these peripherals, see the Device Configurations section
of this data sheet.
VCP
TCP
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
11
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
CPU (DSP core) description
The CPU fetches V elociTI advanced very-long instruction words (VLIWs) (256 bits wide) to supply up to eight
32-bit instructions to the eight functional units during every clock cycle. The VelociTI VLIW architecture
features controls by which all eight units do not have to be supplied with instructions if they are not ready to
execute. The first bit of every 32-bit instruction determines if the next instruction belongs to the same execute
packet as the previous instruction, or whether it should be executed in the following clock as a part of the next
execute packet. Fetch packets are always 256 bits wide; however, the execute packets can vary in size. The
variable-length execute packets are a key memory-saving feature, distinguishing the C64x CPUs from other
VLIW architectures. The C64x VelociTI.2 extensions add enhancements to the TMS320C62x DSP
VelociTI architecture. These enhancements include:
Register file enhancements
Data path extensions
Quad 8-bit and dual 16-bit extensions with data flow enhancements
Additional functional unit hardware
Increased orthogonality of the instruction set
Additional instructions that reduce code size and increase register flexibility
The CPU features two sets of functional units. Each set contains four units and a register file. One set contains
functional units .L1, .S1, .M1, and .D1; the other set contains units .D2, .M2, .S2, and .L2. The two register files
each contain 32 32-bit registers for a total of 64 general-purpose registers. In addition to supporting the packed
16-bit and 32-/40-bit fixed-point data types found in the C62x VelociTI VLIW architecture, the C64x register
files also support packed 8-bit data and 64-bit fixed-point data types. The two sets of functional units, along with
two register files, compose sides A and B of the CPU [see the functional block and CPU (DSP core) diagram,
and Figure 1]. The four functional units on each side of the CPU can freely share the 32 registers belonging to
that side. Additionally, each side features a “data cross path”—a single data bus connected to all the registers
on the other side, by which the two sets of functional units can access data from the register files on the opposite
side. The C64x CPU pipelines data-cross-path accesses over multiple clock cycles. This allows the same
register to be used as a data-cross-path operand by multiple functional units in the same execute packet. All
functional units in the C64x CPU can access operands via the data cross path. Register access by functional
units on the same side of the CPU as the register file can service all the units in a single clock cycle. On the C64x
CPU, a delay clock is introduced whenever an instruction attempts to read a register via a data cross path if that
register was updated in the previous clock cycle.
In addition to the C62x DSP fixed-point instructions, the C64x DSP includes a comprehensive collection of
quad 8-bit and dual 16-bit instruction set extensions. These VelociTI.2 extensions allow the C64x CPU to
operate directly on packed data to streamline data flow and increase instruction set efficiency.
Another key feature of the C64x CPU is the load/store architecture, where all instructions operate on registers
(as opposed to data in memory). Two sets of data-addressing units (.D1 and .D2) are responsible for all data
transfers between the register files and the memory. The data address driven by the .D units allows data
addresses generated from one register file to be used to load or store data to or from the other register file. The
C64x .D units can load and store bytes (8 bits), half-words (16 bits), and words (32 bits) with a single instruction.
And with the new data path extensions, the C64x .D unit can load and store doublewords (64 bits) with a single
instruction. Furthermore, the non-aligned load and store instructions allow the .D units to access words and
doublewords o n any byte boundary. The C64x CPU supports a variety of indirect addressing modes using either
linear- or circular-addressing with 5- or 15-bit of fsets. All instructions are conditional, and most can access any
one of the 64 registers. Some registers, however, are singled out to support specific addressing modes or to
hold the condition for conditional instructions (if the condition is not automatically “true”).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
TMS320C62x is a trademark of Texas Instruments.
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
12 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
CPU (DSP core) description (continued)
The two .M functional units perform all multiplication operations. Each of the C64x .M units can perform two
16 × 16-bit multiplies or four 8 ×8-bit multiplies per clock cycle. The .M unit can also perform 16 ×32-bit multiply
operations, dual 16 ×16-bit multiplies with add/subtract operations, and quad 8 ×8-bit multiplies with add
operations. In addition to standard multiplies, the C64x .M units include bit-count, rotate, Galois field multiplies,
and bidirectional variable shift hardware.
The two .S and .L functional units perform a general set of arithmetic, logical, and branch functions with results
available every clock cycle. The arithmetic and logical functions on the C64x CPU include single 32-bit, dual
16-bit, and quad 8-bit operations.
The processing flow begins when a 256-bit-wide instruction fetch packet is fetched from a program memory.
The 32-bit instructions destined for the individual functional units are “linked” together by “1” bits in the least
significant bit (LSB) position of the instructions. The instructions that are “chained” together for simultaneous
execution (up to eight in total) compose an execute packet. A “0” in the LSB of an instruction breaks the chain,
effectively placing the instructions that follow it in the next execute packet. A C64x DSP device enhancement
now allows execute packets to cross fetch-packet boundaries. In the TMS320C62x/TMS320C67x DSP
devices, if an execute packet crosses the fetch-packet boundary (256 bits wide), the assembler places it i n t h e
next fetch packet, while the remainder of the current fetch packet is padded with NOP instructions. In the C64x
DSP device, the execute boundary restrictions have been removed, thereby, eliminating all of the NOPs added
to pad the fetch packet, and thus, decreasing the overall code size. The number of execute packets within a
fetch packet can vary from one to eight. Execute packets are dispatched to their respective functional units at
the rate of one per clock cycle and the next 256-bit fetch packet is not fetched until all the execute packets from
the current fetch packet have been dispatched. After decoding, the instructions simultaneously drive all active
functional units for a maximum execution rate of eight instructions every clock cycle. While most results are
stored in 32-bit registers, they can be subsequently moved to memory as bytes, half-words, words, or
doublewords. All load and store instructions are byte-, half-word-, word-, or doubleword-addressable.
For more details on the C64x CPU functional units enhancements, see the following documents:
The TMS320C6000 CPU and Instruction Set Reference Guide (literature number SPRU189)
TMS320C64x Technical Overview (literature number SPRU395)
How To Begin Development Today With the TMS320C6414, TMS320C6415, and TMS320C6416 DSPs
application report (literature number SPRA718)
ADVANCE INFORMATION
TMS320C67x is a trademark of Texas Instruments.
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
13
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
CPU (DSP core) description (continued)
.L1
.S1
.M1
.D1
.D2
.M2
.S2
.L2
src1
long dst
88
src2
DA1 (Address)
ST1b (Store Data)
ST2a (Store Data)
Register
File A
(A0−A31)
8
8
88
dst
Data Path A
DA2 (Address)
Register
File B
(B0− B31)
LD2a (Load Data)
Data Path B
Control Register
File
ST2b (Store Data)
LD1b (Load Data)
8
8
2X
1X
ST1a (Store Data)
See Note A
See Note A
LD1a (Load Data)
LD2b (Load Data)
See Note A
See Note A
32 MSBs
32 LSBs
32 MSBs
32 LSBs
32 MSBs
32 LSBs
32 MSBs
32 LSBs
src2
src1
dst
long dst
long src
long src
long dst
dst
src1
src2
src1
src2
src2
src1
dst
src2
src1
dst
src2
long dst
src2
src1
dst
long dst
long dst
long src
long src
long dst
dst
dst
src2
src1
dst
NOTE A: For the .M functional units, the long dst is 32 MSBs and the dst is 32 LSBs.
Figure 1. TMS320C64x CPU (DSP Core) Data Paths
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
14 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
memory map summary
Table 3 shows the memory map address ranges of the TMS320C64x device. Internal memory is always located
at address 0 and can be used as both program and data memory. The external memory address ranges in the
C64x device begin at the hex address locations 0x6000 0000 for EMIFB and 0x8000 0000 for EMIFA.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
15
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
memory map summary (continued)
Table 3. TMS320C64x Memory Map Summary
MEMORY BLOCK DESCRIPTION BLOCK SIZE (BYTES) HEX ADDRESS RANGE
Internal RAM (L2) 1M 0000 0000 – 000F FFFF
Reserved 23M 0010 0000 – 017F FFFF
External Memory Interface A (EMIFA) Registers 256K 0180 0000 – 0183 FFFF
L2 Registers 256K 0184 0000 – 0187 FFFF
HPI Registers 256K 0188 0000 – 018B FFFF
McBSP 0 Registers 256K 018C 0000 – 018F FFFF
McBSP 1 Registers 256K 0190 0000 – 0193 FFFF
Timer 0 Registers 256K 0194 0000 – 0197 FFFF
Timer 1 Registers 256K 0198 0000 – 019B FFFF
Interrupt Selector Registers 256K 019C 0000 – 019F FFFF
EDMA RAM and EDMA Registers 256K 01A0 0000 – 01A3 FFFF
McBSP 2 Registers 256K 01A4 0000 – 01A7 FFFF
EMIFB Registers 256K 01A8 0000 – 01AB FFFF
Timer 2 Registers 256K 01AC 0000 – 01AF FFFF
GPIO Registers 256K 01B0 0000 – 01B3 FFFF
UTOPIA Registers (C6415 and C6416 only)256K 01B4 0000 – 01B7 FFFF
TCP/VCP Registers (C6416 only)256K 01B8 0000 – 01BB FFFF
Reserved 256K 01BC 0000 – 01BF FFFF
PCI Registers (C6415 and C6416 only)256K 01C0 0000 – 01C3 FFFF
Reserved 4M – 256K 01C4 0000 – 01FF FFFF
QDMA Registers 52 0200 0000 – 0200 0033
Reserved 736M – 52 0200 0034 – 2FFF FFFF
McBSP 0 Data 64M 3000 0000 – 33FF FFFF
McBSP 1 Data 64M 3400 0000 – 37FF FFFF
McBSP 2 Data 64M 3800 0000 – 3BFF FFFF
UTOPIA Queues (C6415 and C6416 only)64M 3C00 0000 – 3FFF FFFF
Reserved 256M 4000 0000 – 4FFF FFFF
TCP/VCP (C6416 only)256M 5000 0000 – 5FFF FFFF
EMIFB CE0 64M 6000 0000 – 63FF FFFF
EMIFB CE1 64M 6400 0000 – 67FF FFFF
EMIFB CE2 64M 6800 0000 – 6BFF FFFF
EMIFB CE3 64M 6C00 0000 – 6FFF FFFF
Reserved 256M 7000 0000 – 7FFF FFFF
EMIFA CE0 256M 8000 0000 – 8FFF FFFF
EMIFA CE1 256M 9000 0000 – 9FFF FFFF
EMIFA CE2 256M A000 0000 – AFFF FFFF
EMIFA CE3 256M B000 0000 – BFFF FFFF
Reserved 1G C000 0000 – FFFF FFFF
For the C6414 device, these memory address locations are reserved. The C6414 device does not support the UTOPIA and PCI peripherals.
Only the C6416 device supports the VCP/TCP Coprocessors. For the C6414 and C6415 devices, these memory address locations are reserved.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
16 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
L2 architecture expanded
Figure 2 shows the detail of the L2 architecture on the TMS320C6414, TMS320C6415, and TMS320C6416
devices. For more information on the L2MODE bits, see the cache configuration (CCFG) register bit field
descriptions i n the TMS320C64x Two-Level Internal Memory Reference Guide (literature number SPRU610).
ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ
ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ
ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ
ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ
ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ
ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ
0x0000 0000
011010001 111
0x000C 0000
000
L2MODE L2 Memory Block Base Address
0x000F 0000
0x000E 0000
32K Cache
(4 Way)
64K Cache (4 Way)
128K Cache (4 Way)
256K Cache (4 Way)
1024K SRAM (All)
992K SRAM
960K SRAM
896K SRAM
768K-Byte SRAM
128K-Byte RAM
32K-Byte RAM
0x000F FFFF
64K-Byte RAM
32K-Byte RAM
768K SRAM
0x000F 8000
Figure 2. TMS320C6414/C6415/C6416 L2 Architecture Memory Configuration
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
17
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
peripheral register descriptions
Table 4 through Table 23 identify the peripheral registers for the C6414, C6415, and C6416 devices by their
register names, acronyms, and hex address or hex address range. For more detailed information on the register
contents, bit names and their descriptions, see the specific peripheral reference guide listed in the
TMS320C6000 DSP Peripherals Overview Reference Guide (literature number SPRU190).
Table 4. EMIFA Registers
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME
0180 0000 GBLCTL EMIFA global control
0180 0004 CECTL1 EMIFA CE1 space control
0180 0008 CECTL0 EMIFA CE0 space control
0180 000C Reserved
0180 0010 CECTL2 EMIFA CE2 space control
0180 0014 CECTL3 EMIFA CE3 space control
0180 0018 SDCTL EMIFA SDRAM control
0180 001C SDTIM EMIFA SDRAM refresh control
0180 0020 SDEXT EMIFA SDRAM extension
0180 0024 − 0180 003C Reserved
0180 0040 PDTCTL Peripheral device transfer (PDT) control
0180 0044 CESEC1 EMIFA CE1 space secondary control
0180 0048 CESEC0 EMIFA CE0 space secondary control
0180 004C Reserved
0180 0050 CESEC2 EMIFA CE2 space secondary control
0180 0054 CESEC3 EMIFA CE3 space secondary control
0180 0058 − 0183 FFFF Reserved
Table 5. EMIFB Registers
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME
01A8 0000 GBLCTL EMIFB global control
01A8 0004 CECTL1 EMIFB CE1 space control
01A8 0008 CECTL0 EMIFB CE0 space control
01A8 000C Reserved
01A8 0010 CECTL2 EMIFB CE2 space control
01A8 0014 CECTL3 EMIFB CE3 space control
01A8 0018 SDCTL EMIFB SDRAM control
01A8 001C SDTIM EMIFB SDRAM refresh control
01A8 0020 SDEXT EMIFB SDRAM extension
01A8 0024 − 01A8 003C Reserved
01A8 0040 PDTCTL Peripheral device transfer (PDT) control
01A8 0044 CESEC1 EMIFB CE1 space secondary control
01A8 0048 CESEC0 EMIFB CE0 space secondary control
01A8 004C Reserved
01A8 0050 CESEC2 EMIFB CE2 space secondary control
01A8 0054 CESEC3 EMIFB CE3 space secondary control
01A8 0058 − 01AB FFFF Reserved
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
18 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
peripheral register descriptions (continued)
Table 6. L2 Cache Registers
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME COMMENTS
0184 0000 CCFG Cache configuration register
0184 0004 − 0184 0FFC Reserved
0184 1000 EDMAWEIGHT L2 EDMA access control register
0184 1004 − 0184 1FFC Reserved
0184 2000 L2ALLOC0 L2 allocation register 0
0184 2004 L2ALLOC1 L2 allocation register 1
0184 2008 L2ALLOC2 L2 allocation register 2
0184 200C L2ALLOC3 L2 allocation register 3
0184 2010 − 0184 3FFC Reserved
0184 4000 L2WBAR L2 writeback base address register
0184 4004 L2WWC L2 writeback word count register
0184 4010 L2WIBAR L2 writeback invalidate base address register
0184 4014 L2WIWC L2 writeback invalidate word count register
0184 4018 L2IBAR L2 invalidate base address register
0184 401C L2IWC L2 invalidate word count register
0184 4020 L1PIBAR L1P invalidate base address register
0184 4024 L1PIWC L1P invalidate word count register
0184 4030 L1DWIBAR L1D writeback invalidate base address register
0184 4034 L1DWIWC L1D writeback invalidate word count register
0184 4038 − 0184 4044 Reserved
0184 4048 L1DIBAR L1D invalidate base address register
0184 404C L1DIWC L1D invalidate word count register
0184 4050 − 0184 4FFC Reserved
0184 5000 L2WB L2 writeback all register
0184 5004 L2WBINV L2 writeback invalidate all register
0184 5008 − 0184 7FFC Reserved
0184 8000 − 0184 817C MAR0 to
MAR95 Reserved
0184 8180 MAR96 Controls EMIFB CE0 range 6000 0000 − 60FF FFFF
0184 8184 MAR97 Controls EMIFB CE0 range 6100 0000 − 61FF FFFF
0184 8188 MAR98 Controls EMIFB CE0 range 6200 0000 − 62FF FFFF
0184 818C MAR99 Controls EMIFB CE0 range 6300 0000 − 63FF FFFF
0184 8190 MAR100 Controls EMIFB CE1 range 6400 0000 − 64FF FFFF
0184 8194 MAR101 Controls EMIFB CE1 range 6500 0000 − 65FF FFFF
0184 8198 MAR102 Controls EMIFB CE1 range 6600 0000 − 66FF FFFF
0184 819C MAR103 Controls EMIFB CE1 range 6700 0000 − 67FF FFFF
0184 81A0 MAR104 Controls EMIFB CE2 range 6800 0000 − 68FF FFFF
0184 81A4 MAR105 Controls EMIFB CE2 range 6900 0000 − 69FF FFFF
0184 81A8 MAR106 Controls EMIFB CE2 range 6A00 0000 − 6AFF FFFF
0184 81AC MAR107 Controls EMIFB CE2 range 6B00 0000 − 6BFF FFFF
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
19
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Table 6. L2 Cache Registers (Continued)
HEX ADDRESS RANGE COMMENTSREGISTER NAMEACRONYM
0184 81B0 MAR108 Controls EMIFB CE3 range 6C00 0000 − 6CFF FFFF
0184 81B4 MAR109 Controls EMIFB CE3 range 6D00 0000 − 6DFF FFFF
0184 81B8 MAR110 Controls EMIFB CE3 range 6E00 0000 − 6EFF FFFF
0184 81BC MAR111 Controls EMIFB CE3 range 6F00 0000 − 6FFF FFFF
0184 81C0 − 0184 81FC MAR112 to
MAR127 Reserved
0184 8200 MAR128 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8000 0000 − 80FF FFFF
0184 8204 MAR129 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8100 0000 − 81FF FFFF
0184 8208 MAR130 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8200 0000 − 82FF FFFF
0184 820C MAR131 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8300 0000 − 83FF FFFF
0184 8210 MAR132 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8400 0000 − 84FF FFFF
0184 8214 MAR133 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8500 0000 − 85FF FFFF
0184 8218 MAR134 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8600 0000 − 86FF FFFF
0184 821C MAR135 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8700 0000 − 87FF FFFF
0184 8220 MAR136 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8800 0000 − 88FF FFFF
0184 8224 MAR137 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8900 0000 − 89FF FFFF
0184 8228 MAR138 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8A00 0000 − 8AFF FFFF
0184 822C MAR139 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8B00 0000 − 8BFF FFFF
0184 8230 MAR140 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8C00 0000 − 8CFF FFFF
0184 8234 MAR141 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8D00 0000 − 8DFF FFFF
0184 8238 MAR142 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8E00 0000 − 8EFF FFFF
0184 823C MAR143 Controls EMIFA CE0 range 8F00 0000 − 8FFF FFFF
0184 8240 MAR144 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9000 0000 − 90FF FFFF
0184 8244 MAR145 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9100 0000 − 91FF FFFF
0184 8248 MAR146 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9200 0000 − 92FF FFFF
0184 824C MAR147 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9300 0000 − 93FF FFFF
0184 8250 MAR148 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9400 0000 − 94FF FFFF
0184 8254 MAR149 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9500 0000 − 95FF FFFF
0184 8258 MAR150 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9600 0000 − 96FF FFFF
0184 825C MAR151 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9700 0000 − 97FF FFFF
0184 8260 MAR152 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9800 0000 − 98FF FFFF
0184 8264 MAR153 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9900 0000 − 99FF FFFF
0184 8268 MAR154 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9A00 0000 − 9AFF FFFF
0184 826C MAR155 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9B00 0000 − 9BFF FFFF
0184 8270 MAR156 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9C00 0000 − 9CFF FFFF
0184 8274 MAR157 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9D00 0000 − 9DFF FFFF
0184 8278 MAR158 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9E00 0000 − 9EFF FFFF
0184 827C MAR159 Controls EMIFA CE1 range 9F00 0000 − 9FFF FFFF
0184 8280 MAR160 Controls EMIFA CE2 range A000 0000 − A0FF FFFF
0184 8284 MAR161 Controls EMIFA CE2 range A100 0000 − A1FF FFFF
0184 8288 MAR162 Controls EMIFA CE2 range A200 0000 − A2FF FFFF
0184 828C MAR163 Controls EMIFA CE2 range A300 0000 − A3FF FFFF
0184 8290 MAR164 Controls EMIFA CE2 range A400 0000 − A4FF FFFF
ADVANCE INFORMATION
peripheral register descriptions (continued)
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
20 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Table 6. L2 Cache Registers (Continued)
HEX ADDRESS RANGE COMMENTSREGISTER NAMEACRONYM
0184 8294 MAR165 Controls EMIFA CE2 range A500 0000 − A5FF FFFF
0184 8298 MAR166 Controls EMIFA CE2 range A600 0000 − A6FF FFFF
0184 829C MAR167 Controls EMIFA CE2 range A700 0000 − A7FF FFFF
0184 82A0 MAR168 Controls EMIFA CE2 range A800 0000 − A8FF FFFF
0184 82A4 MAR169 Controls EMIFA CE2 range A900 0000 − A9FF FFFF
0184 82A8 MAR170 Controls EMIFA CE2 range AA00 0000 − AAFF FFFF
0184 82AC MAR171 Controls EMIFA CE2 range AB00 0000 − ABFF FFFF
0184 82B0 MAR172 Controls EMIFA CE2 range AC00 0000 − ACFF FFFF
0184 82B4 MAR173 Controls EMIFA CE2 range AD00 0000 − ADFF FFFF
0184 82B8 MAR174 Controls EMIFA CE2 range AE00 0000 − AEFF FFFF
0184 82BC MAR175 Controls EMIFA CE2 range AF00 0000 − AFFF FFFF
0184 82C0 MAR176 Controls EMIFA CE3 range B000 0000 − B0FF FFFF
0184 82C4 MAR177 Controls EMIFA CE3 range B100 0000 − B1FF FFFF
0184 82C8 MAR178 Controls EMIFA CE3 range B200 0000 − B2FF FFFF
0184 82CC MAR179 Controls EMIFA CE3 range B300 0000 − B3FF FFFF
0184 82D0 MAR180 Controls EMIFA CE3 range B400 0000 − B4FF FFFF
0184 82D4 MAR181 Controls EMIFA CE3 range B500 0000 − B5FF FFFF
0184 82D8 MAR182 Controls EMIFA CE3 range B600 0000 − B6FF FFFF
0184 82DC MAR183 Controls EMIFA CE3 range B700 0000 − B7FF FFFF
0184 82E0 MAR184 Controls EMIFA CE3 range B800 0000 − B8FF FFFF
0184 82E4 MAR185 Controls EMIFA CE3 range B900 0000 − B9FF FFFF
0184 82E8 MAR186 Controls EMIFA CE3 range BA00 0000 − BAFF FFFF
0184 82EC MAR187 Controls EMIFA CE3 range BB00 0000 − BBFF FFFF
0184 82F0 MAR188 Controls EMIFA CE3 range BC00 0000 − BCFF FFFF
0184 82F4 MAR189 Controls EMIFA CE3 range BD00 0000 − BDFF FFFF
0184 82F8 MAR190 Controls EMIFA CE3 range BE00 0000 − BEFF FFFF
0184 82FC MAR191 Controls EMIFA CE3 range BF00 0000 − BFFF FFFF
0184 8300 − 0184 83FC MAR192 to
MAR255 Reserved
0184 8400 − 0187 FFFF Reserved
ADVANCE INFORMATION
peripheral register descriptions (continued)
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
21
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
peripheral register descriptions (continued)
Table 7. EDMA Registers
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME
01A0 FF9C EPRH Event polarity high register
01A0 FFA4 CIPRH Channel interrupt pending high register
01A0 FFA8 CIERH Channel interrupt enable high register
01A0 FFAC CCERH Channel chain enable high register
01A0 FFB0 ERH Event high register
01A0 FFB4 EERH Event enable high register
01A0 FFB8 ECRH Event clear high register
01A0 FFBC ESRH Event set high register
01A0 FFC0 PQAR0 Priority queue allocation register 0
01A0 FFC4 PQAR1 Priority queue allocation register 1
01A0 FFC8 PQAR2 Priority queue allocation register 2
01A0 FFCC PQAR3 Priority queue allocation register 3
01A0 FFDC EPRL Event polarity low register
01A0 FFE0 PQSR Priority queue status register
01A0 FFE4 CIPRL Channel interrupt pending low register
01A0 FFE8 CIERL Channel interrupt enable low register
01A0 FFEC CCERL Channel chain enable low register
01A0 FFF0 ERL Event low register
01A0 FFF4 EERL Event enable low register
01A0 FFF8 ECRL Event clear low register
01A0 FFFC ESRL Event set low register
01A1 0000 − 01A3 FFFF Reserved
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
22 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
peripheral register descriptions (continued)
Table 8. EDMA Parameter RAM
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME COMMENTS
01A0 0000 − 01A0 0017 Parameters for Event 0 (6 words)
01A0 0018 − 01A0 002F Parameters for Event 1 (6 words)
01A0 0030 − 01A0 0047 Parameters for Event 2 (6 words)
01A0 0048 − 01A0 005F Parameters for Event 3 (6 words)
01A0 0060 − 01A0 0077 Parameters for Event 4 (6 words)
01A0 0078 − 01A0 008F Parameters for Event 5 (6 words)
01A0 0090 − 01A0 00A7 Parameters for Event 6 (6 words)
01A0 00A8 − 01A0 00BF Parameters for Event 7 (6 words)
01A0 00C0 − 01A0 00D7 Parameters for Event 8 (6 words)
01A0 00D8 − 01A0 00EF Parameters for Event 9 (6 words)
01A0 00F0 − 01A0 00107 Parameters for Event 10 (6 words)
01A0 0108 − 01A0 011F Parameters for Event 11 (6 words)
01A0 0120 − 01A0 0137 Parameters for Event 12 (6 words)
01A0 0138 − 01A0 014F Parameters for Event 13 (6 words)
01A0 0150 − 01A0 0167 Parameters for Event 14 (6 words)
01A0 0168 − 01A0 017F Parameters for Event 15 (6 words)
01A0 0150 − 01A0 0167 Parameters for Event 16 (6 words)
01A0 0168 − 01A0 017F Parameters for Event 17 (6 words)
... ...
... ...
01A0 05D0 − 01A0 05E7 Parameters for Event 62 (6 words)
01A0 05E8 − 01A0 05FF Parameters for Event 63 (6 words)
01A0 0600 − 01A0 0617 Reload/link parameters for Event M (6 words)
01A0 0618 − 01A0 062F Reload/link parameters for Event N (6 words)
... ...
01A0 07E0 − 01A0 07F7 Reload/link parameters for Event Z (6 words)
01A0 07F8 − 01A0 07FF Scratch pad area (2 words)
The C6414/C6415/C6416 device has twenty-one parameter sets [six (6) words each] that can be used to reload/link EDMA transfers.
Table 9. Quick DMA (QDMA) and Pseudo Registers
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME
0200 0000 QOPT QDMA options parameter register
0200 0004 QSRC QDMA source address register
0200 0008 QCNT QDMA frame count register
0200 000C QDST QDMA destination address register
0200 0010 QIDX QDMA index register
0200 0014 − 0200 001C Reserved
0200 0020 QSOPT QDMA pseudo options register
0200 0024 QSSRC QDMA pseudo source address register
0200 0028 QSCNT QDMA pseudo frame count register
0200 002C QSDST QDMA pseudo destination address register
0200 0030 QSIDX QDMA pseudo index register
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
23
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
peripheral register descriptions (continued)
Table 10. Interrupt Selector Registers
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME COMMENTS
019C 0000 MUXH Interrupt multiplexer high Selects which interrupts drive CPU
interrupts 10−15 (INT10−INT15)
019C 0004 MUXL Interrupt multiplexer low Selects which interrupts drive CPU
interrupts 4−9 (INT04−INT09)
019C 0008 EXTPOL External interrupt polarity Sets the polarity of the external
interrupts (EXT_INT4−EXT_INT7)
019C 000C − 019C 01FF Reserved
Table 11. McBSP 0 Registers
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME COMMENTS
018C 0000 DRR0 McBSP0 data receive register via Configuration Bus The CPU and EDMA controller
can only read this register;
they cannot write to it.
0x3000 0000 − 0x33FF FFFF DRR0 McBSP0 data receive register via Peripheral Bus
018C 0004 DXR0 McBSP0 data transmit register via Configuration Bus
0x3000 0000 − 0x33FF FFFF DXR0 McBSP0 data transmit register via Peripheral Bus
018C 0008 SPCR0 McBSP0 serial port control register
018C 000C RCR0 McBSP0 receive control register
018C 0010 XCR0 McBSP0 transmit control register
018C 0014 SRGR0 McBSP0 sample rate generator register
018C 0018 MCR0 McBSP0 multichannel control register
018C 001C RCERE00 McBSP0 enhanced receive channel enable register 0
018C 0020 XCERE00 McBSP0 enhanced transmit channel enable register 0
018C 0024 PCR0 McBSP0 pin control register
018C 0028 RCERE10 McBSP0 enhanced receive channel enable register 1
018C 002C XCERE10 McBSP0 enhanced transmit channel enable register 1
018C 0030 RCERE20 McBSP0 enhanced receive channel enable register 2
018C 0034 XCERE20 McBSP0 enhanced transmit channel enable register 2
018C 0038 RCERE30 McBSP0 enhanced receive channel enable register 3
018C 003C XCERE30 McBSP0 enhanced transmit channel enable register 3
018C 0040 − 018F FFFF Reserved
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
24 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
peripheral register descriptions (continued)
Table 12. McBSP 1 Registers
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME COMMENTS
0190 0000 DRR1 McBSP1 data receive register via Configuration Bus The CPU and EDMA controller
can only read this register;
they cannot write to it.
0x3400 0000 − 0x37FF FFFF DRR1 McBSP1 data receive register via Peripheral Bus
0190 0004 DXR1 McBSP1 data transmit register via Configuration Bus
0x3400 0000 − 0x37FF FFFF DXR1 McBSP1 data transmit register via Peripheral Bus
0190 0008 SPCR1 McBSP1 serial port control register
0190 000C RCR1 McBSP1 receive control register
0190 0010 XCR1 McBSP1 transmit control register
0190 0014 SRGR1 McBSP1 sample rate generator register
0190 0018 MCR1 McBSP1 multichannel control register
0190 001C RCERE01 McBSP1 enhanced receive channel enable register 0
0190 0020 XCERE01 McBSP1 enhanced transmit channel enable register 0
0190 0024 PCR1 McBSP1 pin control register
0190 0028 RCERE11 McBSP1 enhanced receive channel enable register 1
0190 002C XCERE11 McBSP1 enhanced transmit channel enable register 1
0190 0030 RCERE21 McBSP1 enhanced receive channel enable register 2
0190 0034 XCERE21 McBSP1 enhanced transmit channel enable register 2
0190 0038 RCERE31 McBSP1 enhanced receive channel enable register 3
0190 003C XCERE31 McBSP1 enhanced transmit channel enable register 3
0190 0040 − 0193 FFFF Reserved
Table 13. McBSP 2 Registers
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME COMMENTS
01A4 0000 DRR2 McBSP2 data receive register via Configuration Bus The CPU and EDMA controller
can only read this register;
they cannot write to it.
0x3800 0000 − 0x3BFF FFFF DRR2 McBSP2 data receive register via Peripheral Bus
01A4 0004 DXR2 McBSP2 data transmit register via Configuration Bus
0x3800 0000 − 0x3BFF FFFF DXR2 McBSP2 data transmit register via Peripheral Bus
01A4 0008 SPCR2 McBSP2 serial port control register
01A4 000C RCR2 McBSP2 receive control register
01A4 0010 XCR2 McBSP2 transmit control register
01A4 0014 SRGR2 McBSP2 sample rate generator register
01A4 0018 MCR2 McBSP2 multichannel control register
01A4 001C RCERE02 McBSP2 enhanced receive channel enable register 0
01A4 0020 XCERE02 McBSP2 enhanced transmit channel enable register 0
01A4 0024 PCR2 McBSP2 pin control register
01A4 0028 RCERE12 McBSP2 enhanced receive channel enable register 1
01A4 002C XCERE12 McBSP2 enhanced transmit channel enable register 1
01A4 0030 RCERE22 McBSP2 enhanced receive channel enable register 2
01A4 0034 XCERE22 McBSP2 enhanced transmit channel enable register 2
01A4 0038 RCERE32 McBSP2 enhanced receive channel enable register 3
01A4 003C XCERE32 McBSP2 enhanced transmit channel enable register 3
01A4 0040 − 01A7 FFFF Reserved
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
25
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
peripheral register descriptions (continued)
Table 14. Timer 0 Registers
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME COMMENTS
0194 0000 CTL0 Timer 0 control register Determines the operating
mode of the timer, monitors the
timer status, and controls the
function of the TOUT pin.
0194 0004 PRD0 Timer 0 period register Contains the number of timer
input clock cycles to count.
This number controls the
TSTAT signal frequency.
0194 0008 CNT0 Timer 0 counter register Contains the current value of
the incrementing counter.
0194 000C − 0197 FFFF Reserved
Table 15. Timer 1 Registers
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME COMMENTS
0198 0000 CTL1 Timer 1 control register Determines the operating
mode of the timer, monitors the
timer status, and controls the
function of the TOUT pin.
0198 0004 PRD1 Timer 1 period register Contains the number of timer
input clock cycles to count.
This number controls the
TSTAT signal frequency.
0198 0008 CNT1 Timer 1 counter register Contains the current value of
the incrementing counter.
0198 000C − 019B FFFF Reserved
Table 16. Timer 2 Registers
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME COMMENTS
01AC 0000 CTL2 Timer 2 control register Determines the operating
mode of the timer, monitors the
timer status, and controls the
function of the TOUT pin.
01AC 0004 PRD2 Timer 2 period register Contains the number of timer
input clock cycles to count.
This number controls the
TSTAT signal frequency.
01AC 0008 CNT2 Timer 2 counter register Contains the current value of
the incrementing counter.
01AC 000C − 01AF FFFF Reserved
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
26 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
peripheral register descriptions (continued)
Table 17. HPI Registers
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME COMMENTS
HPID HPI data register Host read/write access only
0188 0000 HPIC HPI control register HPIC has both Host/CPU
read/write access
0188 0004 HPIA
(HPIAW)HPI address register (Write)
HPIA has both Host/CPU
0188 0008 HPIA
(HPIAR)HPI address register (Read)
HPIA has both Host/CPU
read/write access
0188 000C − 0189 FFFF Reserved
018A 0000 TRCTL HPI transfer request control register
018A 0004 − 018B FFFF Reserved
Host access to the HPIA register updates both the HPIAW and HPIAR registers. The CPU can access HPIAW and HPIAR independently.
Table 18. GPIO Registers
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME
01B0 0000 GPEN GPIO enable register
01B0 0004 GPDIR GPIO direction register
01B0 0008 GPVAL GPIO value register
01B0 000C Reserved
01B0 0010 GPDH GPIO delta high register
01B0 0014 GPHM GPIO high mask register
01B0 0018 GPDL GPIO delta low register
01B0 001C GPLM GPIO low mask register
01B0 0020 GPGC GPIO global control register
01B0 0024 GPPOL GPIO interrupt polarity register
01B0 0028 − 01B0 01FF Reserved
01B0 0200 DEVICE_REV Silicon Revision Identification Register
(For more details, see the device characteristics listed in Table 1.)
01B0 0204 − 01B3 FFFF Reserved
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
27
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
peripheral register descriptions (continued)
Table 19. PCI Peripheral Registers (C6415 and C6416 Only)
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME
01C0 0000 RSTSRC DSP Reset source/status register
01C0 0004 Reserved
01C0 0008 PCIIS PCI interrupt source register
01C0 000C PCIIEN PCI interrupt enable register
01C0 0010 DSPMA DSP master address register
01C0 0014 PCIMA PCI master address register
01C0 0018 PCIMC PCI master control register
01C0 001C CDSPA Current DSP address register
01C0 0020 CPCIA Current PCI address register
01C0 0024 CCNT Current byte count register
01C0 0028 Reserved
01C0 002C − 01C1 FFEF Reserved
0x01C1 FFF0 HSR Host status register
0x01C1 FFF4 HDCR Host-to-DSP control register
0x01C1 FFF8 DSPP DSP page register
0x01C1 FFFC Reserved
01C2 0000 EEADD EEPROM address register
01C2 0004 EEDAT EEPROM data register
01C2 0008 EECTL EEPROM control register
01C2 000C − 01C2 FFFF Reserved
01C3 0000 TRCTL PCI transfer request control register
01C3 0004 − 01C3 FFFF Reserved
These PCI registers are not supported on the C6414 device.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
28 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
peripheral register descriptions (continued)
Table 20. UTOPIA (C6415 and C6416 Only)
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME
01B4 0000 UCR UTOPIA control register
01B4 0004 Reserved
01B4 0008 Reserved
01B4 000C UIER UTOPIA interrupt enable register
01B4 0010 UIPR UTOPIA interrupt pending register
01B4 0014 CDR Clock detect register
01B4 0018 EIER Error interrupt enable register
01B4 001C EIPR Error interrupt pending register
01B4 0020 − 01B7 FFFF Reserved
These UTOPIA registers are not supported on the C6414 device.
Table 21. UTOPIA QUEUES (C6415 and C6416 Only)
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME
3C00 0000 URQ UTOPIA receive queue
3D00 0000 UXQ UTOPIA transmit queue
3D00 0004 − 3FFF FFFF Reserved
These UTOPIA registers are not supported on the C6414 device.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
29
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
peripheral register descriptions (continued)
Table 22. VCP Registers (C6416 Only)
EDMA BUS
HEX ADDRESS RANGE PERIPHERAL BUS
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME
5000 0000 01B8 0000 VCPIC0 VCP input configuration register 0
5000 0004 01B8 0004 VCPIC1 VCP input configuration register 1
5000 0008 01B8 0008 VCPIC2 VCP input configuration register 2
5000 000C 01B8 000C VCPIC3 VCP input configuration register 3
5000 0010 01B8 0010 VCPIC4 VCP input configuration register 4
5000 0014 01B8 0014 VCPIC5 VCP input configuration register 5
5000 0040 01B8 0024 VCPOUT0 VCP output register 0
5000 0044 01B8 0028 VCPOUT1 VCP output register 1
5000 0080 VCPWBM VCP branch metrics write register
5000 0088 VCPRDECS VCP decisions read register
01B8 0018 VCPEXE VCP execution register
01B8 0020 VCPEND VCP endian register
01B8 0040 VCPSTAT0 VCP status register 0
01B8 0044 VCPSTAT1 VCP status register 1
01B8 0050 VCPERR VCP error register
These VCP registers are supported on the C6416 device only.
Table 23. TCP Registers (C6416 Only)
EDMA BUS
HEX ADDRESS RANGE PERIPHERAL BUS
HEX ADDRESS RANGE ACRONYM REGISTER NAME
5800 0000 01BA 0000 TCPIC0 TCP input configuration register 0
5800 0004 01BA 0004 TCPIC1 TCP input configuration register 1
5800 0008 01BA 0008 TCPIC2 TCP input configuration register 2
5800 000C 01BA 000C TCPIC3 TCP input configuration register 3
5800 0010 01BA 0010 TCPIC4 TCP input configuration register 4
5800 0014 01BA 0014 TCPIC5 TCP input configuration register 5
5800 0018 01BA 0018 TCPIC6 TCP input configuration register 6
5800 001C 01BA 001C TCPIC7 TCP input configuration register 7
5800 0020 01BA 0020 TCPIC8 TCP input configuration register 8
5800 0024 01BA 0024 TCPIC9 TCP input configuration register 9
5800 0028 01BA 0028 TCPIC10 TCP input configuration register 10
5800 002C 01BA 002C TCPIC11 TCP input configuration register 11
5800 0030 01BA 0030 TCPOUT TCP output parameters register
5802 0000 TCPSP TCP systematics and parities memory
5804 0000 TCPEXT TCP extrinsics memory
5806 0000 TCPAP TCP apriori memory
5808 0000 TCPINTER TCP interleaver memory
580A 0000 TCPHD TCP hard decisions memory
01BA 0038 TCPEXE TCP execution register
01BA 0040 TCPEND TCP endian register
01BA 0050 TCPERR TCP error register
01BA 0058 TCPSTAT TCP status register
These TCP registers are supported on the C6416 device only.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
30 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
EDMA channel synchronization events
The C64x EDMA supports up to 64 EDMA channels which service peripheral devices and external memory.
Table 24 lists the source of C64x EDMA synchronization events associated with each of the programmable
EDMA channels. For the C64x device, the association of an event to a channel is fixed; each of the EDMA
channels has one specific event associated with it. These specific events are captured in the EDMA event
registers (ERL, ERH) even if the events are disabled by the EDMA event enable registers (EERL, EERH). The
priority of e a c h e v e n t c a n b e specified independently in the transfer parameters stored in the EDMA parameter
RAM. For more detailed information on the EDMA module and how EDMA events are enabled, captured,
processed, linked, chained, and cleared, etc., see the TMS320C6000 DSP Enhanced Direct Memory Access
(EDMA) Controller Reference Guide (literature number SPRU234).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
31
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
EDMA channel synchronization events (continued)
Table 24. TMS320C64x EDMA Channel Synchronization Events
EDMA
CHANNEL EVENT NAME EVENT DESCRIPTION
0 DSP_INT HPI/PCI-to-DSP interrupt (PCI peripheral supported on C6415 and C6416 only)
1 TINT0 Timer 0 interrupt
2 TINT1 Timer 1 interrupt
3 SD_INTA EMIFA SDRAM timer interrupt
4 GPINT4/EXT_INT4 GPIO event 4/External interrupt pin 4
5 GPINT5/EXT_INT5 GPIO event 5/External interrupt pin 5
6 GPINT6/EXT_INT6 GPIO event 6/External interrupt pin 6
7 GPINT7/EXT_INT7 GPIO event 7/External interrupt pin 7
8 GPINT0 GPIO event 0
9 GPINT1 GPIO event 1
10 GPINT2 GPIO event 2
11 GPINT3 GPIO event 3
12 XEVT0 McBSP0 transmit event
13 REVT0 McBSP0 receive event
14 XEVT1 McBSP1 transmit event
15 REVT1 McBSP1 receive event
16 None
17 XEVT2 McBSP2 transmit event
18 REVT2 McBSP2 receive event
19 TINT2 Timer 2 interrupt
20 SD_INTB EMIFB SDRAM timer interrupt
21 Reserved, for future expansion
22−27 None
28 VCPREVT VCP receive event (C6416 only)§
29 VCPXEVT VCP transmit event (C6416 only)§
30 TCPREVT TCP receive event (C6416 only)§
31 TCPXEVT TCP transmit event (C6416 only)§
32 UREVT UTOPIA receive event (C6415 and C6416 only)
33−39 None
40 UXEVT UTOPIA transmit event (C6415 and C6416 only)
41−47 None
48 GPINT8 GPIO event 8
49 GPINT9 GPIO event 9
50 GPINT10 GPIO event 10
51 GPINT11 GPIO event 11
52 GPINT12 GPIO event 12
53 GPINT13 GPIO event 13
54 GPINT14 GPIO event 14
55 GPINT15 GPIO event 15
56−63 None
In addition to the events shown in this table, each of the 64 channels can also be synchronized with the transfer completion or alternate transfer
completion events. For more detailed information on EDMA event-transfer chaining, see the TMS320C6000 DSP Enhanced Direct Memory
Access (EDMA) Controller Reference Guide (literature number SPRU234).
The PCI and UTOPIA peripherals are not supported on the C6414 device; therefore, these EDMA synchronization events are reserved.
§The VCP/TCP EDMA synchronization events are supported on the C6416 only. For the C6414 and C6415 devices, these events are reserved.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
32 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
interrupt sources and interrupt selector
The C64x DSP core supports 16 prioritized interrupts, which are listed in Table 25. The highest-priority interrupt
is INT_00 (dedicated to RESET) while the lowest-priority interrupt is INT_15. The first four interrupts
(INT_00−INT_03) are non-maskable and fixed. The remaining interrupts (INT_04−INT_15) are maskable and
default t o the interrupt source specified in Table 25. The interrupt source for interrupts 4−15 can be programmed
by modifying the selector value (binary value) in the corresponding fields of the Interrupt Selector Control
registers: MUXH (address 0x019C0000) and MUXL (address 0x019C0004).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
33
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
interrupt sources and interrupt selector (continued)
Table 25. C64x DSP Interrupts
CPU
INTERRUPT
NUMBER
INTERRUPT
SELECTOR
CONTROL
REGISTER
SELECTOR
VALUE
(BINARY)
INTERRUPT
EVENT INTERRUPT SOURCE
INT_00 RESET
INT_01 NMI
INT_02 Reserved Reserved. Do not use.
INT_03 Reserved Reserved. Do not use.
INT_04MUXL[4:0] 00100 GPINT4/EXT_INT4 GPIO interrupt 4/External interrupt pin 4
INT_05MUXL[9:5] 00101 GPINT5/EXT_INT5 GPIO interrupt 5/External interrupt pin 5
INT_06MUXL[14:10] 00110 GPINT6/EXT_INT6 GPIO interrupt 6/External interrupt pin 6
INT_07MUXL[20:16] 00111 GPINT7/EXT_INT7 GPIO interrupt 7/External interrupt pin 7
INT_08MUXL[25:21] 01000 EDMA_INT EDMA channel (0 through 63) interrupt
INT_09MUXL[30:26] 01001 EMU_DTDMA EMU DTDMA
INT_10MUXH[4:0] 00011 SD_INTA EMIFA SDRAM timer interrupt
INT_11MUXH[9:5] 01010 EMU_RTDXRX EMU real-time data exchange (RTDX)
receive
INT_12MUXH[14:10] 01011 EMU_RTDXTX EMU RTDX transmit
INT_13MUXH[20:16] 00000 DSP_INT HPI/PCI-to-DSP interrupt
(PCI supported on C6415 and C6416 only)
INT_14MUXH[25:21] 00001 TINT0 Timer 0 interrupt
INT_15MUXH[30:26] 00010 TINT1 Timer 1 interrupt
01100 XINT0 McBSP0 transmit interrupt
01101 RINT0 McBSP0 receive interrupt
01110 XINT1 McBSP1 transmit interrupt
01111 RINT1 McBSP1 receive interrupt
10000 GPINT0 GPIO interrupt 0
10001 XINT2 McBSP2 transmit interrupt
10010 RINT2 McBSP2 receive interrupt
10011 TINT2 Timer 2 interrupt
10100 SD_INTB EMIFB SDRAM timer interrupt
10101 Reserved Reserved. Do not use.
10110 Reserved Reserved. Do not use.
10111 UINT UTOPIA interrupt (C6415/C6416 only)
11000 − 11101 Reserved Reserved. Do not use.
11110 VCPINT VCP interrupt (C6416 only)
11111 TCPINT TCP interrupt (C6416 only)
Interrupts INT_00 through INT_03 are non-maskable and fixed.
Interrupts INT_04 through INT_15 are programmable by modifying the binary selector values in the Interrupt Selector Control
registers fields. Table 25 shows the default interrupt sources for Interrupts INT_04 through INT_15. For more detailed
information on interrupt sources and selection, see the TMS320C6000 DSP Interrupt Selector Reference Guide (literature
number SPRU646).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
34 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
signal groups description
TRST
GP7/EXT_INT7
IEEE Standard
1149.1
(JTAG)
Emulation
Reserved
Reset and
Interrupts
Control/Status
TDI
TDO
TMS
TCK
EMU0
EMU1
NMI
GP6/EXT_INT6
GP5/EXT_INT5
GP4/EXT_INT4
RESET
RSV
RSV
RSV
RSV
Clock/PLL
CLKIN
CLKMODE1
CLKMODE0
PLLV
EMU2
EMU3
EMU4
EMU5
RSV
GPIO
General-Purpose Input/Output (GPIO) Port
GP7/EXT_INT7
GP6/EXT_INT6
GP5/EXT_INT5
GP4/EXT_INT4
GP3
CLKOUT6/GP2
CLKOUT4/GP1
GP0
CLKOUT6/GP2
CLKOUT4/GP1
EMU6
EMU7
EMU8
EMU9
EMU10
GP15/PRST§
GP14/PCLK§
GP13/PINTA§
GP12/PGNT§
GP11/PREQ§
GP10/PCBE3§
GP9/PIDSEL§
CLKS2/GP8
These pins are muxed with the GPIO port pins and by default these signals function as clocks (CLKOUT4 or CLKOUT6) or McBSP2
clock source (CLKS2). To use these muxed pins as GPIO signals, the appropriate GPIO register bits (GPxEN and GPxDIR) must be
properly enabled and configured. For more details, see the Device Configurations section of this data sheet.
These pins are GPIO pins that can also function as external interrupt sources (EXT_INT[7:4]). Default after reset is EXT_INTx or
GPIO as input-only.
RSV
EMU11
RSV
RSV
RSV
Peripheral
Control/Status PCI_EN
MCBSP2_EN
For the C6415 and C6416 devices, these GPIO pins are muxed with the PCI peripheral pins. By default, these signals are set up to
no function with both the GPIO and PCI pin functions disabled. For more details on these muxed pins, see the Device Configurations
section of this data sheet. For the C6414 device, the GPIO peripheral pins are not muxed; the C6414 device does not support the
PCI peripheral.
§
Figure 3. CPU and Peripheral Signals
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
35
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
signal groups description (continued)
ACE3 AECLKOUT1
AED[63:0]
ACE2
ACE1
ACE0
AEA[22:3]
ABE7
ABE6
ABE5
ABE4
AARDY
Data
Memory Map
Space Select
Address
Byte Enables
64
20
External
Memory I/F
Control
EMIFA (64-bit)
AECLKIN
AHOLD
AHOLDA
ABUSREQ
Bus
Arbitration
AARE/ASDCAS/ASADS/ASR
E
ASDCKE
AECLKOUT2
ASOE3
ABE3
ABE2
ABE1
ABE0
BCE3
BED[15:0]
BCE2
BCE1
BCE0
BEA[20:1]
Data
Memory Map
Space Select
Address
Byte Enables
16
External
Memory I/F
Control
BECLKIN
BHOLD
BHOLDA
BBUSREQ
Bus
Arbitration
BSOE3
BBE1
BBE0
EMIFB (16-bit)
BECLKOUT1
BARDY
BECLKOUT2
AAOE/ASDRAS/ASOE
AAWE/ASDWE/ASWE
BARE/BSDCAS/BSADS/BSR
E
BAOE/BSDRAS/BSOE
BAWE/BSDWE/BSWE
BPDT
APDT
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (64-bit EMIFA and 16-bit EMIFB). The prefix “A” in front of a signal name indicates it is
an EMIFA signal whereas a prefix “B” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFB signal. Throughout the rest of this document,
in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted from the signal name.
20
Figure 4. Peripheral Signals
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
36 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
signal groups description (continued)
HHWIL/PTRDY
HCNTL0/PSTOP
HCNTL1/PDEVSEL
Data
Register Select
Half-Word
Select
Control
HPI
(Host-Port Interface)
32
HD[31:0]/AD[31:0]
HAS/PPAR
HR/W/PCBE2
HCS/PPERR
HDS1/PSERR
HDS2/PCBE1
HRDY/PIRDY
HINT/PFRAME
(HPI16 ONLY)
For the C6415 and C6416 devices, these HPI pins are muxed with the PCI peripheral. By default, these signals function as HPI. For
more details on these muxed pins, see the Device Configurations section of this data sheet. For the C6414 device, these HPI pins are
not muxed; the C6414 device does not support the PCI peripheral.
For the C6415 and C6416 devices, these PCI pins (excluding PCBE0 and XSP_CS) are muxed with the HPI, McBSP2, or GPIO
peripherals. By default, these signals function as HPI, McBSP2, and no function, respectively. For more details on these muxed pins,
see the Device Configurations section of this data sheet. For the C6414 device, the HPI, McBSP2, and GPIO peripheral pins are not
muxed; the C6414 device does not support the PCI peripheral.
§For the C6414 device, these pins are “Reserved (leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground).”
HD[31:0]/AD[31:0]
HR/W/PCBE2
HDS2/PCBE1
PCBE0§
GP12/PGNT
GP11/PREQ
GP14/PCLK
HINT/PFRAME
GP13/PINTA
Data/Address
Arbitration
32 Clock
Control
PCI Interface
(C6415 and C6416 Only)
HAS/PPAR
GP15/PRST
HRDY/PIRDY
HCNTL0/PSTOP
HHWIL/PTRDY
GP10/PCBE3
GP9/PIDSEL
HCNTL1/PDEVSEL
HDS1/PSERR
Error
Command
Byte Enable
Serial
EEPROM
DX2/XSP_DO
XSP_CS§
CLKX2/XSP_CLK
DR2/XSP_DI
HCS/PPERR
Figure 4. Peripheral Signals (Continued)
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
37
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
signal groups description (continued)
McBSPs
(Multichannel Buffered
Serial Ports)
CLKX0
FSX0
DX0
CLKR0
FSR0
DR0
CLKS0
Transmit
McBSP0
Receive
Clock
CLKX1/URADDR4
FSX1/UXADDR3
DX1/UXADDR4
CLKR1/URADDR2
FSR1/UXADDR2
DR1/UXADDR1
CLKS1/URADDR3
Transmit
McBSP1
Receive
Clock
CLKX2/XSP_CLK
FSX2
DX2/XSP_DO
CLKR2
FSR2
DR2/XSP_DI
CLKS2/GP8
Transmit
McBSP2
Receive
Clock
For the C6415 and C6416 devices, these McBSP2 and McBSP1 pins are muxed with the PCI and UTOPIA peripherals, respectively.
By default, these signals function as McBSP2 and McBSP1, respectively. For more details on these muxed pins, see the Device
Configurations section of this data sheet.
For the C6414 device, these McBSP2 and McBSP1 peripheral pins are not muxed; the C6414 device does not support PCI and UTOPIA
peripherals.
The McBSP2 clock source pin (CLKS2, default) is muxed with the GP8 pin. To use this muxed pin as the GP8 signal, the appropriate
GPIO register bits (GP8EN and GP8DIR) must be properly enabled and configured. For more details, see the Device Configurations
section of this data sheet.
Figure 4. Peripheral Signals (Continued)
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
38 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
signal groups description (continued)
CLKR1/URADDR2Control/Status
CLKX1/URADDR4
URDATA0
URDATA1
CLKS1/URADDR3
URADDR1
URADDR0
Receive
URDATA7
URDATA4
URDATA3
URDATA2
URCLAV
URENB
URDATA5
URDATA6
URSOC
URCLK Clock
Control/Status
Transmit
Clock
FSR1/UXADDR2
DX1/UXADDR4
UXDATA0
UXDATA1
FSX1/UXADDR3
DR1/UXADDR1
UXADDR0
UXDATA7
UXDATA4
UXDATA3
UXDATA2
UXCLAV
UXENB
UXDATA5
UXDATA6
UXSOC
UXCLK
UTOPIA (SLAVE) [C6415 and C6416 Only]
For the C6415 and C6416 devices, these UTOPIA pins are muxed with the McBSP1 peripheral. By default, these signals function as
McBSP1. For more details on these muxed pins, see the Device Configurations section of this data sheet.
For the C6414 device, these McBSP1 peripheral pins are not muxed; the C6414 does not support the UTOPIA peripheral.
TOUT0
Timers
TINP0
TOUT1 Timer 1
TINP1
TOUT2 Timer 2
TINP2
Timer 0
Figure 4. Peripheral Signals (Continued)
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
39
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
DEVICE CONFIGURATIONS
The C6414, C6415, and C6416 peripheral selections and other device configurations are determined by
external pullup/pulldown resistors on the following pins (all of which are latched during device reset):
peripherals selection (C6415 and C6416 devices)
BEA11 (UTOPIA_EN)
PCI_EN (for C6415 or C6416, see Table 27 footnotes)
MCBSP2_EN (for C6415 or C6416, see Table 27 footnotes)
The C6414 device does not support the PCI and UTOPIA peripherals; for proper operation of the C6414
device, do not oppose the internal pulldowns (IPDs) on the BEA11, PCI_EN, and MCBSP2_EN pins. (For
IPUs/IPDs on pins, see the Terminal Functions table of this data sheet.)
other device configurations (C64x)
BEA[20:13, 7]
HD5
peripherals selection
Some C6415/C6416 peripherals share the same pins (internally muxed) and are mutually exclusive (i.e., HPI,
general-purpose input/output pins GP[15:9], PCI and its internal EEPROM, McBSP1, McBSP2, and UTOPIA).
The VCP/TCP coprocessors (C6416 only) and other C64x peripherals (i.e., the Timers, McBSP0, and the
GP[8:0] pins), are always available.
UTOPIA and McBSP1 peripherals
The UTOPIA_EN pin (BEA11) is latched at reset. For C6415 and C6416 devices, this pin selects whether
the UTOPIA peripheral or McBSP1 peripheral is functionally enabled (see Table 26).
The C6414 device does not support the UTOPIA peripheral; for proper device operation, do not oppose the
internal pulldown (IPD) on the BEA11 pin.
Table 26. UTOPIA_EN Peripheral Selection (McBSP1 and UTOPIA) (C6415/C6416 Only)
PERIPHERAL SELECTION PERIPHERALS SELECTED
UTOPIA_EN
(BEA11) Pin [D16] UTOPIA McBSP1 DESCRIPTION
0McBSP1 is enabled and UTOPIA is disabled [default].
This means all multiplexed McBSP1/UTOPIA pins function as McBSP1
and all other standalone UTOPIA pins are tied-off (Hi-Z).
1UTOPIA is enabled and McBSP1 is disabled.
This means all multiplexed McBSP1/UTOPIA pins now function as
UTOPIA and all other standalone McBSP1 pins are tied-off (Hi-Z).
HPI, GP[15:9], PCI, EEPROM (internal to PCI), and McBSP2 peripherals
The PCI_EN and MCBSP2_EN pins are latched at reset. They determine specific peripheral selection for
the C6415 and C6416 devices, summarized in Table 27.
The C6414 device does not support the PCI peripheral; for proper device operation, do not oppose the
internal pulldowns (IPDs) on the PCI_EN and MCBSP2_EN pins.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
40 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
DEVICE CONFIGURATIONS (CONTINUED)
Table 27. PCI_EN and MCBSP2_EN Peripheral Selection (HPI, GP[15:9], PCI, and McBSP2)
PERIPHERAL SELECTIONPERIPHERALS SELECTED
PCI_EN
Pin [AA4] MCBSP2_EN
Pin [AF3] HPI GP[15:9] PCI EEPROM
(Internal to PCI) McBSP2
0 0
0 1
1 0
1 1
The PCI_EN pin must be driven valid at all times and the user must not switch values throughout device operation.
The MCBSP2_EN pin must be driven valid at all times and the user can switch values throughout device operation.
The only time McBSP2 is disabled is when both PCI_EN = 1 and MCBSP2_EN = 0. This configuration enables, at reset, the auto-initialization
of the PCI peripheral through the PCI internal EEPROM [provided the PCI EEPROM Auto-Initialization pin (BEA13) is pulled up
(EEAI = 1)]. The user can then enable the McBSP2 peripheral (disabling EEPROM) by dynamically changing MCBSP2_EN to a “1” after the
device is initialized (out of reset).
If the PCI is disabled (PCI_EN = 0), the HPI peripheral is enabled and GP[15:9] pins can be programmed
as GPIO, provided the GPxEN and GPxDIR bits are properly configured.
This means all multiplexed HPI/PCI pins function as HPI and all standalone PCI pins (PCBE0 and
XSP_CS) are tied-off (Hi-Z). Also, the multiplexed GPIO/PCI pins can be used as GPIO with the
proper software configuration of the GPIO enable and direction registers (for more details, see
Table 29).
If the PCI is enabled (PCI_EN = 1), the HPI peripheral is disabled.
This means all multiplexed HPI/PCI pins function as PCI. Also, the multiplexed GPIO/PCI pins function
as PCI pins (for more details, see Table 29).
The MCBSP2_EN pin, in combination with the PCI_EN pin, controls the selection of the McBSP2
peripheral and the PCI internal EEPROM (for more details, see Table 27 and its footnotes).
other device configurations
Table 28 describes the C6414, C6415, and C6416 devices configuration pins, which are set up via external
pullup/pulldown resistors through the specified EMIFB address bus pins (BEA[20:13, 11, 9:7]) and the HD5 pin.
For more details on these device configuration pins, see the Terminal Functions table and the Debugging
Considerations section.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
41
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
DEVICE CONFIGURATIONS (CONTINUED)
Table 28. Device Configuration Pins (BEA[20:13, 9:7], HD5, and BEA11)
CONFIGURATION
PIN NO. FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
BEA20 E16 Device Endian mode (LEND)
0 System operates in Big Endian mode
1 System operates in Little Endian mode (default)
BEA[19:18] [D18,
C18]
Bootmode [1:0]
00 No boot
01 HPI boot
10 EMIFB 8-bit ROM boot with default timings (default mode)
11 Reserved
BEA[17:16] [B18,
A18]
EMIFA input clock select
Clock mode select for EMIFA (AECLKIN_SEL[1:0])
00 AECLKIN (default mode)
01 CPU/4 Clock Rate
10 CPU/6 Clock Rate
11 Reserved
BEA[15:14] [D17,
C17]
EMIFB input clock select
Clock mode select for EMIFB (BECLKIN_SEL[1:0])
00 BECLKIN (default mode)
01 CPU/4 Clock Rate
10 CPU/6 Clock Rate
11 Reserved
BEA13 B17
PCI EEPROM Auto-Initialization (EEAI) [C6415 and C6416 devices only]
[The C6414 device does not support the PCI peripheral; for proper device operation, do not oppose the
internal pulldown (IPD) on the BEA13 pin.]
PCI auto-initialization via external EEPROM
0 PCI auto-initialization through EEPROM is disabled; the PCI peripheral uses the specified
PCI default values (default).
1 PCI auto-initialization through EEPROM is enabled; the PCI peripheral is configured
through EEPROM provided the PCI peripheral pin is enabled (PCI_EN = 1) and the
McBSP2 peripheral pin is disabled (MCBSP2_EN = 0).
Note: If the PCI peripheral is disabled (PCI_EN pin = 0), this pin must not be pulled up.
For more information on the PCI EEPROM default values, see the TMS320C6000 DSP Peripheral
Component Interconnect (PCI) Reference Guide (literature number SPRU581).
BEA11 D16
UTOPIA Enable (UTOPIA_EN) [C6415 and C6416 devices only]
[The C6414 device does not support the UTOPIA peripheral; for proper device operation, do not
oppose the internal pulldown (IPD) on the BEA11 pin.]
UTOPIA peripheral enable (functional)
0 UTOPIA peripheral disabled (McBSP1 functions are enabled). [default]
This means all multiplexed McBSP1/UTOPIA pins function as McBSP1 and all other
standalone UTOPIA pins are tied-off (Hi-Z).
1 UTOPIA peripheral enabled (McBSP1 functions are disabled).
This means all multiplexed McBSP1/UTOPIA pins now function as UTOPIA and all other
standalone McBSP1 pins are tied-off (Hi-Z).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
42 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
DEVICE CONFIGURATIONS (CONTINUED)
Table 28. Device Configuration Pins (BEA[20:13, 9:7], HD5, and BEA11) (Continued)
CONFIGURATION
PIN NO. FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
BEA7
BEA8
BEA9
D15
A16
B16
C6414 Devices C6415 Devices C6416 Devices
Do not oppose internal pulldown (IPD) PullupDo not oppose IPD
Do not oppose IPD Do not oppose IPD Pullup
Do not oppose IPD Do not oppose IPD Pullup
For proper device operation, this pin must be externally pulled up with a 1-kresistor.
HD5 Y1
HPI peripheral bus width (HPI_WIDTH)
0 HPI operates as an HPI16.
(HPI bus is 16 bits wide. HD[15:0] pins are used and the remaining HD[31:16] pins are
reserved pins in the Hi-Z state.)
1 HPI operates as an HPI32.
(HPI bus is 32 bits wide. All HD[31:0] pins are used for host-port operations.)
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
43
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
DEVICE CONFIGURATIONS (CONTINUED)
multiplexed pins
Multiplexed pins are pins that are shared by more than one peripheral and are internally multiplexed. Some of
these pins are configured by software, and the others are configured by external pullup/pulldown resistors only
at reset. Those muxed pins that are configured by software can be programmed to switch functionalities at any
time. Those muxed pins that are configured by external pullup/pulldown resistors are mutually exclusive; only
one peripheral has primary control of the function of these pins after reset. Table 29 identifies the multiplexed
pins on the C6414, C6415, and C6416 devices; shows the default (primary) function and the default settings
after reset; and describes the pins, registers, etc. necessary to configure specific multiplexed functions.
debugging considerations
It is recommended that external connections be provided to device configuration pins, including
CLKMODE[1:0], BEA[20:13, 11, 9:7], HD5/AD5, PCI_EN, and MCBSP2_EN. Although internal pullup/pulldown
resistors exist on these pins (except for HD5/AD5), providing external connectivity adds convenience to the user
in debugging and flexibility in switching operating modes.
Internal pullup/pulldown resistors also exist on the non-configuration pins on the BEA bus (BEA[12, 10, 6:1]).
Do not oppose the internal pullup/pulldown resistors on these non-configuration pins with external
pullup/pulldown resistors. If an external controller provides signals to these non-configuration pins, these
signals must be driven to the default state of the pins at reset, or not be driven at all.
For the internal pullup/pulldown resistors on the C6414, C6415, and C6416 device pins, see the terminal
functions table.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
44 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
DEVICE CONFIGURATIONS (CONTINUED)
Table 29. C6414, C6415, and C6416 Device Multiplexed Pins
MULTIPLEXED PINS
DEFAULT FUNCTION
DEFAULT SETTING
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
DEFAULT FUNCTION
DEFAULT SETTING
DESCRIPTION
CLKOUT4/GP1AE6 CLKOUT4 GP1EN = 0 (disabled) These pins are software-configurable
.
To use these pins as GPIO pins, the
GPxEN bits in the GPIO Enable
CLKOUT6/GP2AD6 CLKOUT6 GP2EN = 0 (disabled)
GPxEN bits in the GPIO Enable
Register and the GPxDIR bits in the
GPIO Direction Register must be
properly configured.
CLKS2/GP8AE4 CLKS2 GP8EN = 0 (disabled)
properly configured.
GPxEN = 1: GPx pin enabled
GPxDIR = 0: GPx pin is an input
GPxDIR = 1: GPx pin is an output
GP9/PIDSEL M3 To use GP[15:9] as GPIO pins, the PC
I
needs to be disabled (PCI_EN = 0), the
GP10/PCBE3 L2
To use GP[15:9] as GPIO pins, the PCI
needs to be disabled (PCI_EN = 0), the
GPxEN bits in the GPIO Enable
GP11/PREQ F1
GPxEN = 0 (disabled)
GPxEN bits in the GPIO Enable
Register and the GPxDIR bits in the
GP12/PGNT J3 None GPxEN = 0 (disabled)
PCI_EN = 0 (disabled)
Register and the GPxDIR bits in the
GPIO Direction Register must be
properly configured.
GP13/PINTA G4
None
PCI_EN = 0 (disabled)
GPIO Direction Register must be
properly configured.
GPxEN = 1: GPx pin enabled
GP14/PCLK F2
GPxEN = 1: GPx pin enabled
GPxDIR = 0: GPx pin is an input
GP15/PRST G3
GPxDIR = 0: GPx pin is an input
GPxDIR = 1: GPx pin is an output
DX1/UXADDR4 AB11 DX1
FSX1/UXADDR3 AB13 FSX1
By default, McBSP1 is enabled upon
FSR1/UXADDR2 AC9 FSR1
UTOPIA_EN (BEA11) = 0
By default, McBSP1 is enabled upon
reset (UTOPIA is disabled).
To enable the UTOPIA peripheral, an
DR1/UXADDR1 AF11 DR1 UTOPIA_EN (BEA11) = 0
(disabled)
reset (UTOPIA is disabled).
To enable the UTOPIA peripheral, an
external pullup resistor (1 k) must be
CLKX1/URADDR4 AB12 CLKX1
(disabled)
external pullup resistor (1 k
) must be
provided on the BEA11 pin (setting
CLKS1/URADDR3 AC8 CLKS1
provided on the BEA11 pin (setting
UTOPIA_EN = 1 at reset).
CLKR1/URADDR2 AC10 CLKR1
UTOPIA_EN = 1 at reset).
CLKX2/XSP_CLK AC2 CLKX2
DR2/XSP_DI AB3 DR2
DX2/XSP_DO AA2 DX2
HD[31:0]/AD[31:0] §HD[31:0]
HAS/PPAR T3 HAS
By default, HPI is enabled upon reset
HCNTL1/PDEVSEL R1 HCNTL1 By default, HPI is enabled upon rese
t
(PCI is disabled).
HCNTL0/PSTOP T4 HCNTL0
PCI_EN = 0 (disabled)
(PCI is disabled).
To enable the PCI peripheral an external
HDS1/PSERR T1 HDS1 PCI_EN = 0 (disabled)
To enable the PCI peripheral an external
pullup resistor (1 k) must be provided
on the PCI_EN pin (setting PCI_EN = 1
HDS2/PCBE1 T2 HDS2
pullup resistor (1 k ) must be provided
on the PCI_EN pin (setting PCI_EN = 1
at reset).
HR/W/PCBE2 P1 HR/W
at reset).
HHWIL/PTRDY R3 HHWIL (HPI16 only)
HINT/PFRAME R4 HINT
HCS/PPERR R2 HCS
HRDY/PIRDY P4 HRDY
For the C6415 and C6416 devices, all other standalone UTOPIA and PCI pins are tied-of f internally (pins in Hi-Z) when the peripheral is disabled
[UTOPIA_EN (BEA11) = 0 or PCI_EN = 0].
The C6414 device does not support the PCI and UTOPIA peripherals. These are the only multiplexed pins on the C6414 device, all other pins
are standalone peripheral functions and are not muxed.
§For the HD[31:0]/AD[31:0] multiplexed pins pin numbers, see the Terminal Functions table.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
45
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions
SIGNAL
IPD/
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
IPU
DESCRIPTION
CLOCK/PLL CONFIGURATION
CLKIN H4 I IPD Clock Input. This clock is the input to the on-chip PLL.
CLKOUT4/GP1§AE6 I/O/Z IPD Clock output at 1/4 of the device speed (O/Z) [default] or this pin can be programmed as a
GPIO 1 pin (I/O/Z).
CLKOUT6/GP2§AD6 I/O/Z IPD Clock output at 1/6 of the device speed (O/Z) [default] or this pin can be programmed as a
GPIO 2 pin (I/O/Z).
CLKMODE1 G1 I IPD Clock mode select
Selects whether the CPU clock frequency = input clock frequency x1 (Bypass), x6, or x12.
CLKMODE0 H2 I IPD
Selects whether the CPU clock frequency = input clock frequency x1 (Bypass), x6, or x12.
For more details on the CLKMODE pins and the PLL multiply factors, see the Clock PLL
section of this data sheet.
PLLVJ6 A#PLL voltage supply
JTAG EMULATION
TMS AB16 I IPU JTAG test-port mode select
TDO AE19 O/Z IPU JTAG test-port data out
TDI AF18 I IPU JTAG test-port data in
TCK AF16 I IPU JTAG test-port clock
TRST AB15 I IPD JTAG test-port reset. For IEEE 1149.1 JTAG compatibility, see the IEEE 1149.1 JTAG
Compatibility Statement section of this data sheet.
EMU11 AC18 I/O/Z IPU Emulation pin 11. Reserved for future use, leave unconnected.
EMU10 AD18 I/O/Z IPU Emulation pin 10. Reserved for future use, leave unconnected.
EMU9 AE18 I/O/Z IPU Emulation pin 9. Reserved for future use, leave unconnected.
EMU8 AC17 I/O/Z IPU Emulation pin 8. Reserved for future use, leave unconnected.
EMU7 AF17 I/O/Z IPU Emulation pin 7. Reserved for future use, leave unconnected.
EMU6 AD17 I/O/Z IPU Emulation pin 6. Reserved for future use, leave unconnected.
EMU5 AE17 I/O/Z IPU Emulation pin 5. Reserved for future use, leave unconnected.
EMU4 AC16 I/O/Z IPU Emulation pin 4. Reserved for future use, leave unconnected.
EMU3 AD16 I/O/Z IPU Emulation pin 3. Reserved for future use, leave unconnected.
EMU2 AE16 I/O/Z IPU Emulation pin 2. Reserved for future use, leave unconnected.
EMU1
EMU0 AC15
AF15 I/O/Z IPU
Emulation [1:0] pins
Select the device functional mode of operation
EMU[1:0] Operation
00 Boundary Scan/Normal Mode (see Note)
01 Reserved
10 Reserved
11 Emulation/Normal Mode [default] (see the IEEE 1149.1 JTAG
Compatibility Statement section of this data sheet)
Normal mode refers to the DSPs normal operational mode, when the DSP is free running. The
DSP can be placed in normal operational mode when the EMU[1:0] pins are configured for
either Boundary Scan or Emulation.
Note: When the EMU[1:0] pins are configured for Boundary Scan mode, the internal pulldown
(IPD) on the TRST signal must not be opposed in order to operate in Normal mode.
For the Boundary Scan mode pulldown EMU[1:0] pins with a dedicated 1-k resister.
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
IPD = Internal pulldown, IPU = Internal pullup. (These IPD/IPU signal pins feature a 30-k IPD or IPU resistor. To pull up a signal to the opposite
supply rail, a 1-kresistor should be used.)
§These pins are multiplexed pins. For more details, see the Device Configurations section of this data sheet.
PLLV is not part of external voltage supply. See the Clock PLL section for information on how to connect this pin.
#A = Analog signal (PLL Filter)
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
46 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
IPU
DESCRIPTION
RESETS, INTERRUPTS, AND GENERAL-PURPOSE INPUT/OUTPUTS
RESET AC7 I Device reset
NMI B4 I IPD Nonmaskable interrupt, edge-driven (rising edge)
GP7/EXT_INT7 AF4 General-purpose input/output (GPIO) pins (I/O/Z) or external interrupts (input only). The
default after reset setting is GPIO enabled as input-only.
GP6/EXT_INT6 AD5
General-purpose input/output (GPIO) pins (I/O/Z) or external interrupts (input only). The
default after reset setting is GPIO enabled as input-only.
When these pins function as External Interrupts [by selecting the corresponding interrupt
GP5/EXT_INT5 AE5 I/O/Z IPU
When these pins function as External Interrupts [by selecting the corresponding interrupt
enable register bit (IER.[7:4])], they are edge-driven and the polarity can be
GP4/EXT_INT4 AF5
enable register bit (IER.[7:4])], they are edge-driven and the polarity can be
independently selected via the External Interrupt Polarity Register bits (EXTPOL.[3:0])
.
GP15/PRST§G3 General-purpose input/output (GPIO) 15 pin (I/O/Z) or PCI reset (I). No function at default.
GP14/PCLK§F2 GPIO 14 pin (I/O/Z) or PCI clock (I). No function at default.
GP13/PINTA§G4 GPIO 13 pin (I/O/Z) or PCI interrupt A (O/Z). No function at default.
GP12/PGNT§J3 GPIO 12 pin (I/O/Z) or PCI bus grant (I). No function at default.
GP11/PREQ§F1 GPIO 11 pin (I/O/Z) or PCI bus request (O/Z). No function at default.
GP10/PCBE3§L2
GPIO 10 pin (I/O/Z) or PCI command/byte enable 3 (I/O/Z). No function at default.
GP9/PIDSEL§M3
GPIO 9 pin (I/O/Z) or PCI initialization device select (I). No function at default.
GP3 AC6 IPD GPIO 3 pin (I/O/Z). The default after reset setting is GPIO 3 enabled as input-only.
GP0 AF6 IPD
GPIO 0 pin.
The general-purpose I/O 0 pin (GPIO 0) (I/O/Z) can be programmed as GPIO 0 (input only)
[default] o r a s G PIO 0 (output only) pin or output as a general-purpose interrupt (GP0INT)
signal (output only).
CLKS2/GP8§¶ AE4 I/O/Z IPD McBSP2 external clock source (CLKS2) [input only] [default] or this pin can be pro-
grammed as a GPIO 8 pin (I/O/Z).
CLKOUT6/GP2§¶ AD6 I/O/Z IPD Clock output at 1/6 of the device speed (O/Z) [default] or this pin can be programmed as a
GPIO 2 pin (I/O/Z).
CLKOUT4/GP1§¶ AE6 I/O/Z IPD Clock output at 1/4 of the device speed (O/Z) [default] or this pin can be programmed as a
GPIO 1 pin (I/O/Z).
HOST-PORT INTERFACE (HPI) [C64x] or PERIPHERAL COMPONENT INTERCONNECT (PCI) [C6415 or C6416 devices only]
PCI_EN AA4 I IPD
PCI enable pin. This pin controls the selection (enable/disable) of the HPI and GP[15:9], or
PCI peripherals (for the C6415 and C6416 devices). This pin works in conjunction with the
MCBSP2_EN pin to enable/disable other peripherals (for more details, see the Device Con-
figurations section of this data sheet).
The C6414 device does not support the PCI peripheral; for proper device operation, do not
oppose the internal pulldown (IPD) on this pin.
HINT/PFRAME§R4 I/O/Z Host interrupt from DSP to host (O) [default] or PCI frame (I/O/Z)
HCNTL1/
PDEVSEL§R1 I/O/Z Host control − selects between control, address, or data registers (I) [default] or PCI device
select (I/O/Z).
HCNTL0/
PSTOP§T4 I/O/Z Host control − selects between control, address, or data registers (I) [default] or PCI stop
(I/O/Z)
HHWIL/PTRDY§R3 I/O/Z Host half-word select − first or second half-word (not necessarily high or low order)
[For HPI16 bus width selection only] (I) [default] or PCI target ready (I/O/Z)
HR/W/PCBE2§P1 I/O/Z Host read or write select (I) [default] or PCI command/byte enable 2 (I/O/Z)
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
IPD = Internal pulldown, IPU = Internal pullup. (These IPD/IPU signal pins feature a 30-k IPD or IPU resistor. To pull up a signal to the opposite
supply rail, a 1-kresistor should be used.)
§For the C6415 and C6416 devices, these pins are multiplexed pins. For more details, see the Device Configurations section of this data sheet.
The C6414 device does not support the PCI or UTOPIA peripherals; therefore, these muxed peripheral pins are standalone peripheral functions
for this device.
For the C6414 device, only these pins are multiplexed pins.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
47
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
IPU
DESCRIPTION
HOST-PORT INTERFACE (HPI) [C64x] or PERIPHERAL COMPONENT INTERCONNECT (PCI) [C6415 or C6416 devices only]
(CONTINUED)
HAS/PPAR§T3 I/O/Z Host address strobe (I) [default] or PCI parity (I/O/Z)
HCS/PPERR§R2 I/O/Z Host chip select (I) [default] or PCI parity error (I/O/Z)
HDS1/PSERR§T1 I/O/Z Host data strobe 1 (I) [default] or PCI system error (I/O/Z)
HDS2/PCBE1§T2 I/O/Z Host data strobe 2 (I) [default] or PCI command/byte enable 1 (I/O/Z)
HRDY/PIRDY§P4 I/O/Z Host ready from DSP to host (O) [default] or PCI initiator ready (I/O/Z).
HD31/AD31§J2
HD30/AD30§K3
HD29/AD29§J1
HD28/AD28§K4
HD27/AD27§K2
HD26/AD26§L3
HD25/AD25§K1
HD24/AD24§L4
HD23/AD23§L1
HD22/AD22§M4 Host-port data (I/O/Z) [default] (C64x) or PCI data-address bus (I/O/Z) [C6415 and C6416]
HD21/AD21§M2
As HPI data bus (PCI_EN pin = 0)
HD20/AD20§N4
As HPI data bus (PCI_EN pin = 0)
Used for transfer of data, address, and control
HD19/AD19§M1
Used for transfer of data, address, and control
Host-Port bus width user-configurable at device reset via a 10-kresistor pullup/pulldown
resistor on the HD5 pin:
HD18/AD18§N5
resistor on the HD5 pin:
HD17/AD17§N1 HD5 pin = 0: HPI operates as an HPI16.
(HPI bus is 16 bits wide. HD[15:0] pins are used and the remaining HD[31:16] pins are
HD16/AD16§P5
HD5 pin = 0: HPI operates as an HPI16.
(HPI bus is 16 bits wide. HD[15:0] pins are used and the remaining HD[31:16] pins are
reserved pins in the high-impedance state.)
HD15/AD15§U4 I/O/Z
reserved pins in the high-impedance state.)
HD14/AD14§U1 HD5 pin = 1: HPI operates as an HPI32.
(HPI bus is 32 bits wide. All HD[31:0] pins are used for host-port operations.)
HD13/AD13§U3
HD5 pin = 1: HPI operates as an HPI32.
(HPI bus is 32 bits wide. All HD[31:0] pins are used for host-port operations.)
HD12/AD12§U2
As PCI data-address bus (PCI_EN pin = 1) [C6415 and C6416 devices only]
HD11/AD11§V4
As PCI data-address bus (PCI_EN pin = 1) [C6415 and C6416 devices only]
Used for transfer of data and address
HD10/AD10§V1
Used for transfer of data and address
The C6414 device does not support the PCI peripheral; therefore, the HPI peripheral pins are
HD9/AD9§V3
The C6414 device does not support the PCI peripheral; therefore, the HPI peripheral pins are
standalone peripheral functions, not muxed.
HD8/AD8§V2
standalone peripheral functions, not muxed.
HD7/AD7§W2
HD6/AD6§W4
HD5/AD5§Y1
HD4/AD4§Y3
HD3/AD3§Y2
HD2/AD2§Y4
HD1/AD1§AA1
HD0/AD0§AA3
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
IPD = Internal pulldown, IPU = Internal pullup. (These IPD/IPU signal pins feature a 30-k IPD or IPU resistor. To pull up a signal to the opposite
supply rail, a 1-kresistor should be used.)
§For the C6415 and C6416 devices, these pins are multiplexed pins. For more details, see the Device Configurations section of this data sheet.
The C6414 device does not support the PCI or UTOPIA peripherals; therefore, these muxed peripheral pins are standalone peripheral functions
for this device.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
48 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
IPU
DESCRIPTION
HOST-PORT INTERFACE (HPI) [C64x] or PERIPHERAL COMPONENT INTERCONNECT (PCI) [C6415 or C6416 devices only]
(CONTINUED)
PCBE0 W3 I/O/Z PCI command/byte enable 0 (I/O/Z). When PCI is disabled (PCI_EN = 0), this pin is tied-off.
For the C6414 device this pin is “Reserved (leave unconnected, do not connect to power or
ground).”
XSP_CS AD1 O IPD PCI serial interface chip select (O). When PCI is disabled (PCI_EN = 0), this pin is tied-off.
For the C6414 device this pin is “Reserved (leave unconnected, do not connect to power or
ground).”
CLKX2/
XSP_CLK§AC2 I/O/Z IPD McBSP2 transmit clock (I/O/Z) [default] or PCI serial interface clock (O) (PCI_EN = 1).
DR2/XSP_DI§AB3 I IPU McBSP2 receive data (I) [default] or PCI serial interface data in (I). In PCI mode (PCI_EN = 1),
this pin is connected to the output data pin of the serial PROM.
DX2/XSP_DO§AA2 O/Z IPU McBSP2 transmit data (O/Z) [default] or PCI serial interface data out (O). In PCI mode
(PCI_EN = 1), this pin is connected to the input data pin of the serial PROM.
GP15/PRST§G3 General-purpose input/output (GPIO) 15 pin (I/O/Z) or PCI reset (I). No function at default.
GP14/PCLK§F2 GPIO 14 pin (I/O/Z) or PCI clock (I). No function at default.
GP13/PINTA§G4 GPIO 13 pin (I/O/Z) or PCI interrupt A (O/Z). No function at default.
GP12/PGNT§J3 I/O/Z GPIO 12 pin (I/O/Z) or PCI bus grant (I). No function at default.
GP11/PREQ§F1
GPIO 11 pin (I/O/Z) or PCI bus request (O/Z). No function at default.
GP10/PCBE3§L2 GPIO 10 pin (I/O/Z) or PCI command/byte enable 3 (I/O/Z). No function at default.
GP9/PIDSEL§M3 GPIO 9 pin (I/O/Z) or PCI initialization device select (I). No function at default.
EMIFA (64-bit) − CONTROL SIGNALS COMMON TO ALL TYPES OF MEMORY||
ACE3 L26 O/Z IPU
EMIFA memory space enables
ACE2 K23 O/Z IPU EMIFA memory space enables
Enabled by bits 28 through 31 of the word address
ACE1 K24 O/Z IPU
Enabled by bits 28 through 31 of the word address
Only one pin is asserted during any external data access
ACE0 K25 O/Z IPU
Only one pin is asserted during any external data access
ABE7 T23 O/Z IPU
ABE6 T24 O/Z IPU
ABE5 R25 O/Z IPU EMIFA byte-enable control
Decoded from the low-order address bits. The number of address bits or byte enables
ABE4 R26 O/Z IPU
EMIFA byte-enable control
Decoded from the low-order address bits. The number of address bits or byte enables
used depends on the width of external memory.
ABE3 M25 O/Z IPU
used depends on the width of external memory.
Byte-write enables for most types of memory
ABE2 M26 O/Z IPU
Byte-write enables for most types of memory
Can be directly connected to SDRAM read and write mask signal (SDQM)
ABE1 L23 O/Z IPU
Can be directly connected to SDRAM read and write mask signal (SDQM)
ABE0 L24 O/Z IPU
APDT M22 O/Z IPU EMIFA peripheral data transfer, allows direct transfer between external peripherals
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
IPD = Internal pulldown, IPU = Internal pullup. (These IPD/IPU signal pins feature a 30-k IPD or IPU resistor. To pull up a signal to the opposite
supply rail, a 1-kresistor should be used.)
§For the C6415 and C6416 devices, these pins are multiplexed pins. For more details, see the Device Configurations section of this data sheet.
The C6414 device does not support the PCI or UTOPIA peripherals; therefore, these muxed peripheral pins are standalone peripheral functions
for this device.
|| These C64x devices have two EMIFs (64-bit EMIFA and 16-bit EMIFB). The prefix “A” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFA signal
whereas a prefix “B” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFB signal. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of
discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted from the signal name.
To maintain signal integrity for the EMIF signals, serial termination resistors should be inserted into all EMIF output signal lines.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
49
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
IPU
DESCRIPTION
EMIFA (64-BIT) − BUS ARBITRATION||
AHOLDA N22 O IPU EMIFA hold-request-acknowledge to the host
AHOLD V23 I IPU EMIFA hold request from the host
ABUSREQ P22 O IPU EMIFA bus request output
EMIFA (64-BIT) − ASYNCHRONOUS/SYNCHRONOUS MEMORY CONTROL||
AECLKIN H25 I IPD EMIFA external input clock. The EMIFA input clock (AECLKIN, CPU/4 clock, or CPU/6 clock)
is selected at reset via the pullup/pulldown resistors on the BEA[17:16] pins.
AECLKIN is the default for the EMIFA input clock.
AECLKOUT2 J23 O/Z IPD EMIFA output clock 2. Programmable to be EMIFA input clock (AECLKIN, CPU/4 clock, or
CPU/6 clock) frequency divided-by-1, -2, or -4.
AECLKOUT1 J26 O/Z IPD EMIFA output clock 1 [at EMIFA input clock (AECLKIN, CPU/4 clock, or CPU/6 clock)
frequency].
AARE/
ASDCAS/
ASADS/ASRE J25 O/Z IPU
EMIFA asynchronous memory read-enable/SDRAM column-address strobe/programmable
synchronous interface-address strobe or read-enable
For programmable synchronous interface, the RENEN field in the CE Space Secondary
Control Register (CExSEC) selects between ASADS and ASRE:
If RENEN = 0, then the ASADS/ASRE signal functions as the ASADS signal.
If RENEN = 1, then the ASADS/ASRE signal functions as the ASRE signal.
AAOE/
ASDRAS/
ASOE J24 O/Z IPU EMIFA asynchronous memory output-enable/SDRAM row-address strobe/programmable
synchronous interface output-enable
AAWE/
ASDWE/
ASWE K26 O/Z IPU EMIFA asynchronous memory write-enable/SDRAM write-enable/programmable synchro-
nous interface write-enable
ASDCKE L25 O/Z IPU EMIFA SDRAM clock-enable (used for self-refresh mode). [EMIFA module only.]
If SDRAM is not in system, ASDCKE can be used as a general-purpose output.
ASOE3 R22 O/Z IPU EMIFA synchronous memory output-enable for ACE3 (for glueless FIFO interface)
AARDY L22 I IPU Asynchronous memory ready input
EMIFA (64-BIT) − ADDRESS||
AEA22 T22
AEA21 V24
AEA20 V25
AEA19 V26
AEA18 U23
AEA17 U24
EMIFA external address (doubleword address)
AEA16 U25 O/Z IPD EMIFA external address (doubleword address)
AEA15 U26
AEA14 T25
AEA13 T26
AEA12 R23
AEA11 R24
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
IPD = Internal pulldown, IPU = Internal pullup. (These IPD/IPU signal pins feature a 30-k IPD or IPU resistor. To pull up a signal to the opposite
supply rail, a 1-kresistor should be used.)
|| These C64x devices have two EMIFs (64-bit EMIFA and 16-bit EMIFB). The prefix “A” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFA signal
whereas a prefix “B” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFB signal. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of
discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted from the signal name.
To maintain signal integrity for the EMIF signals, serial termination resistors should be inserted into all EMIF output signal lines.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
50 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
IPU
DESCRIPTION
EMIFA (64-BIT) − ADDRESS|| (CONTINUED)
AEA10 P23
AEA9 P24
AEA8 P26
AEA7 N23
EMIFA external address (doubleword address)
AEA6 N24 O/Z IPD EMIFA external address (doubleword address)
AEA5 N26
AEA4 M23
AEA3 M24
EMIFA (64-bit) − DATA||
AED63 AF24
AED62 AF23
AED61 AE23
AED60 AE22
AED59 AD22
AED58 AF22
AED57 AD21
AED56 AE21
AED55 AC21
AED54 AF21
AED53 AD20
AED52 AE20
AED51 AC20
AED50 AF20 I/O/Z IPU EMIFA external data
AED49 AC19
EMIFA external data
AED48 AD19
AED47 W24
AED46 W23
AED45 Y26
AED44 Y23
AED43 Y25
AED42 Y24
AED41 AA26
AED40 AA23
AED39 AA25
AED38 AA24
AED37 AB26
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
IPD = Internal pulldown, IPU = Internal pullup. (These IPD/IPU signal pins feature a 30-k IPD or IPU resistor. To pull up a signal to the opposite
supply rail, a 1-kresistor should be used.)
|| These C64x devices have two EMIFs (64-bit EMIFA and 16-bit EMIFB). The prefix “A” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFA signal
whereas a prefix “B” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFB signal. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of
discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted from the signal name.
To maintain signal integrity for the EMIF signals, serial termination resistors should be inserted into all EMIF output signal lines.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
51
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
IPU
DESCRIPTION
EMIFA (64-bit) − DATA|| (CONTINUED)
AED36 AB24
AED35 AB25
AED34 AC25
AED33 AC26
AED32 AD26
AED31 C26
AED30 D26
AED29 D25
AED28 E25
AED27 E24
AED26 E26
AED25 F24
AED24 F25
AED23 F23
AED22 F26
AED21 G24
AED20 G25
AED19 G23
AED18 G26 I/O/Z IPU EMIFA external data
AED17 H23
EMIFA external data
AED16 H24
AED15 C19
AED14 D19
AED13 A20
AED12 D20
AED11 B20
AED10 C20
AED9 A21
AED8 D21
AED7 B21
AED6 C21
AED5 A22
AED4 C22
AED3 B22
AED2 B23
AED1 A23
AED0 A24
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
IPD = Internal pulldown, IPU = Internal pullup. (These IPD/IPU signal pins feature a 30-k IPD or IPU resistor. To pull up a signal to the opposite
supply rail, a 1-kresistor should be used.)
|| These C64x devices have two EMIFs (64-bit EMIFA and 16-bit EMIFB). The prefix “A” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFA signal
whereas a prefix “B” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFB signal. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of
discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted from the signal name.
To maintain signal integrity for the EMIF signals, serial termination resistors should be inserted into all EMIF output signal lines.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
52 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
IPU
DESCRIPTION
EMIFB (16-bit) − CONTROL SIGNALS COMMON TO ALL TYPES OF MEMORY||
BCE3 A13 O/Z IPU
EMIFB memory space enables
BCE2 C12 O/Z IPU EMIFB memory space enables
Enabled by bits 26 through 31 of the word address
BCE1 B12 O/Z IPU
Enabled by bits 26 through 31 of the word address
Only one pin is asserted during any external data access
BCE0 A12 O/Z IPU
Only one pin is asserted during any external data access
BBE1 D13 O/Z IPU EMIFB byte-enable control
Decoded from the low-order address bits. The number of address bits or byte enables
used depends on the width of external memory.
BBE0 C13 O/Z IPU
used depends on the width of external memory.
Byte-write enables for most types of memory
Can be directly connected to SDRAM read and write mask signal (SDQM)
BPDT E12 O/Z IPU EMIFB peripheral data transfer, allows direct transfer between external peripherals
EMIFB (16-BIT) − BUS ARBITRATION||
BHOLDA E13 O IPU EMIFB hold-request-acknowledge to the host
BHOLD B19 I IPU EMIFB hold request from the host
BBUSREQ E14 O IPU EMIFB bus request output
EMIFB (16-BIT) − ASYNCHRONOUS/SYNCHRONOUS MEMORY CONTROL||
BECLKIN A11 I IPD EMIFB external input clock. The EMIFB input clock (BECLKIN, CPU/4 clock, or CPU/6 clock)
is selected at reset via the pullup/pulldown resistors on the BEA[15:14] pins.
BECLKIN is the default for the EMIFB input clock.
BECLKOUT2 D11 O/Z IPD EMIFB output clock 2. Programmable to be EMIFB input clock (BECLKIN, CPU/4 clock, or
CPU/6 clock) frequency divided by 1, 2, or 4.
BECLKOUT1 D12 O/Z IPD EMIFB output clock 1 [at EMIFB input clock (BECLKIN, CPU/4 clock, or CPU/6 clock)
frequency].
BARE/
BSDCAS/
BSADS/BSRE A10 O/Z IPU
EMIFB asynchronous memory read-enable/SDRAM column-address strobe/programmable
synchronous interface-address strobe or read-enable
For programmable synchronous interface, the RENEN field in the CE Space Secondary
Control Register (CExSEC) selects between BSADS and BSRE:
If RENEN = 0, then the BSADS/BSRE signal functions as the BSADS signal.
If RENEN = 1, then the BSADS/BSRE signal functions as the BSRE signal.
BAOE/
BSDRAS/
BSOE B11 O/Z IPU EMIFB asynchronous memory output-enable/SDRAM row-address strobe/programmable
synchronous interface output-enable
BAWE/BSDWE/
BSWE C11 O/Z IPU EMIFB asynchronous memory write-enable/SDRAM write-enable/programmable synchro-
nous interface write-enable
BSOE3 E15 O/Z IPU EMIFB synchronous memory output enable for BCE3 (for glueless FIFO interface)
BARDY E11 I IPU EMIFB asynchronous memory ready input
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
IPD = Internal pulldown, IPU = Internal pullup. (These IPD/IPU signal pins feature a 30-k IPD or IPU resistor. To pull up a signal to the opposite
supply rail, a 1-kresistor should be used.)
|| These C64x devices have two EMIFs (64-bit EMIFA and 16-bit EMIFB). The prefix “A” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFA signal
whereas a prefix “B” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFB signal. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of
discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted from the signal name.
To maintain signal integrity for the EMIF signals, serial termination resistors should be inserted into all EMIF output signal lines.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
53
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
IPU
DESCRIPTION
EMIFB (16-BIT) − ADDRESS||
BEA20 E16 IPU EMIFB external address (half-word address) (O/Z)
Also controls initialization of DSP modes at reset (I) via pullup/pulldown resistors
− Device Endian mode
BEA19 D18 IPU
Also controls initialization of DSP modes at reset (I) via pullup/pulldown resistors
− Device Endian mode
BEA20: 0 Big Endian
1 Little Endian (default mode)
BEA18 C18
1 Little Endian (default mode)
− Boot mode
BEA[19:18]: 00 No boot
01 HPI boot
BEA17 B18
BEA[19:18]: 00 No boot
01 HPI boot
10 EMIFB 8-bit ROM boot with default timings (default mode)
11 Reserved
BEA16 A18
11 Reserved
− EMIF clock select
BEA15 D17
− EMIF clock select
BEA[17:16]: Clock mode select for EMIFA (AECLKIN_SEL[1:0])
00 AECLKIN (default mode)
01 CPU/4 Clock Rate
BEA14 C17 01 CPU/4 Clock Rate
10 CPU/6 Clock Rate
11 Reserved
BEA13 B17
11 Reserved
BEA[15:14]: Clock mode select for EMIFB (BECLKIN_SEL[1:0])
00 BECLKIN (default mode)
BEA12 A17
BEA[15:14]: Clock mode select for EMIFB (BECLKIN_SEL[1:0])
00 BECLKIN (default mode)
01 CPU/4 Clock Rate
10 CPU/6 Clock Rate
BEA11 D16
10 CPU/6 Clock Rate
11 Reserved
BEA10 C16
− PCI EEPROM Auto-Initialization (EEAI) [C6415 and C6416 devices only]
BEA13: PCI auto-initialization via external EEPROM
If the PCI peripheral is disabled (PCI_EN pin = 0), this pin must not be pulled up.
BEA9 B16
If the PCI peripheral is disabled (PCI_EN pin = 0), this pin must not be pulled up.
0 PCI auto-initialization through EEPROM is disabled (default)
.
1 PCI auto-initialization through EEPROM is enabled.
BEA8 A16
1 PCI auto-initialization through EEPROM is enabled.
− UTOPIA Enable (UTOPIA_EN) [C6415 and C6416 devices only]
BEA11: UTOPIA peripheral enable (functional)
BEA7 D15
UTOPIA Enable (UTOPIA_EN) [C6415 and C6416 devices only]
BEA11: UTOPIA peripheral enable (functional)
0 UTOPIA disabled (McBSP1 enabled) [default]
1 UTOPIA enabled (McBSP1 disabled)
BEA6 C15
1 UTOPIA enabled (McBSP1 disabled)
The C6414 device does not support the PCI and UTOPIA peripherals; for proper device
do not
BEA5 B15
The C6414 device does not support the PCI and UTOPIA peripherals; for proper device
operation, do not oppose the internal pulldowns (IPDs) on the BEA13 and BEA11 pins.
Also for proper C6414 device operation, do not oppose the IPDs on the BEA7, BEA8,
BEA4 A15
Also for proper C6414 device operation, do not oppose the IPDs on the BEA7, BEA8,
and BEA9 pins.
BEA3 D14 For proper C6415 device operation, the BEA7 pin must be externally pulled up with a
1-k resistor.
BEA2 C14
1-k resistor.
For proper C6416 device operation, the BEA8 and BEA9 pins must be externally pulled
up with a 1-k resistor.
BEA1 A14
up with a 1-k
resistor.
For more details, see the Device Configurations section of this data sheet.
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
IPD = Internal pulldown, IPU = Internal pullup. (These IPD/IPU signal pins feature a 30-k IPD or IPU resistor. To pull up a signal to the opposite
supply rail, a 1-kresistor should be used.)
|| These C64x devices have two EMIFs (64-bit EMIFA and 16-bit EMIFB). The prefix “A” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFA signal
whereas a prefix “B” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFB signal. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of
discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted from the signal name.
To maintain signal integrity for the EMIF signals, serial termination resistors should be inserted into all EMIF output signal lines.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
54 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
IPU
DESCRIPTION
EMIFB (16-bit) − DATA||
BED15 D7
BED14 B6
BED13 C7
BED12 A6
BED11 D8
BED10 B7
BED9 C8
BED8 A7
EMIFB external data
BED7 C9 I/O/Z IPU EMIFB external data
BED6 B8
BED5 D9
BED4 B9
BED3 C10
BED2 A9
BED1 D10
BED0 B10
MULTICHANNEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT 2 (McBSP2)
MCBSP2_EN AF3 I IPD McBSP2 enable pin. This pin works in conjunction with the PCI_EN pin to enable/disable other
peripherals (for more details, see the Device Configurations section of this data sheet).
CLKS2/GP8§AE4 I/O/Z IPD McBSP2 external clock source (CLKS2) [input only] [default] or this pin can also be
programmed as a GPIO 8 pin (I/O/Z).
CLKR2 AB1 I/O/Z IPD McBSP2 receive clock. When McBSP2 is disabled (PCI_EN = 1 and MCBSP2_EN pin = 0),
this pin is tied-off.
CLKX2/
XSP_CLK§AC2 I/O/Z IPD McBSP2 transmit clock (I/O/Z) [default] or PCI serial interface clock (O).
DR2/XSP_DI§AB3 I IPU McBSP2 receive data (I) [default] or PCI serial interface data in (I). In PCI mode, this pin is
connected to the output data pin of the serial PROM.
DX2/XSP_DO§AA2 O/Z IPU McBSP2 transmit data (O/Z) [default] or PCI serial interface data out (O). In PCI mode, this pin
is connected to the input data pin of the serial PROM.
FSR2 AC1 I/O/Z IPD McBSP2 receive frame sync. When McBSP2 is disabled (PCI_EN = 1 and MCBSP2_EN pin
= 0), this pin is tied-off.
FSX2 AB2 I/O/Z IPD McBSP2 transmit frame sync. When McBSP2 is disabled (PCI_EN = 1 and MCBSP2_EN pin
= 0), this pin is tied-off.
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
IPD = Internal pulldown, IPU = Internal pullup. (These IPD/IPU signal pins feature a 30-k IPD or IPU resistor. To pull up a signal to the opposite
supply rail, a 1-kresistor should be used.)
§For the C6415 and C6416 devices, these pins are multiplexed pins. For more details, see the Device Configurations section of this data sheet.
The C6414 device does not support the PCI or UTOPIA peripherals; therefore, these muxed peripheral pins except CLKS2/GP8 are standalone
peripheral functions for this device.
|| These C64x devices have two EMIFs (64-bit EMIFA and 16-bit EMIFB). The prefix “A” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFA signal
whereas a prefix “B” in front of a signal name indicates it is an EMIFB signal. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of
discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted from the signal name.
To maintain signal integrity for the EMIF signals, serial termination resistors should be inserted into all EMIF output signal lines.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
55
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
IPU
DESCRIPTION
MULTICHANNEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT 1 (McBSP1)
CLKS1/
URADDR3§AC8 I McBSP1 external clock source (as opposed to internal) (I) [default] or UTOPIA receive
address 3 pin (I)
CLKR1/
URADDR2§AC10 I/O/Z McBSP1 receive clock (I/O/Z) [default] or UTOPIA receive address 2 pin (I)
CLKX1/
URADDR4§AB12 I/O/Z McBSP1 transmit clock (I/O/Z) [default] or UTOPIA receive address 4 pin (I)
DR1/
UXADDR1§AF11 I McBSP1 receive data (I) [default] or UTOPIA transmit address 1 pin (I)
DX1/
UXADDR4§AB11 I/O/Z McBSP1 transmit data (O/Z) [default] or UTOPIA transmit address 4 pin (I)
FSR1/
UXADDR2§AC9 I/O/Z McBSP1 receive frame sync (I/O/Z) [default] or UTOPIA transmit address 2 pin (I)
FSX1/
UXADDR3§AB13 I/O/Z McBSP1 transmit frame sync (I/O/Z) [default] or UTOPIA transmit address 3 pin (I)
MULTICHANNEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT 0 (McBSP0)
CLKS0 F4 I IPD McBSP0 external clock source (as opposed to internal)
CLKR0 D1 I/O/Z IPD McBSP0 receive clock
CLKX0 E1 I/O/Z IPD McBSP0 transmit clock
DR0 D2 I IPU McBSP0 receive data
DX0 E2 O/Z IPU McBSP0 transmit data
FSR0 C1 I/O/Z IPD McBSP0 receive frame sync
FSX0 E3 I/O/Z IPD McBSP0 transmit frame sync
TIMER 2
TOUT2 A4 O/Z IPD Timer 2 or general-purpose output
TINP2 C5 I IPD Timer 2 or general-purpose input
TIMER 1
TOUT1 B5 O/Z IPD Timer 1 or general-purpose output
TINP1 A5 I IPD Timer 1 or general-purpose input
TIMER 0
TOUT0 D6 O/Z IPD Timer 0 or general-purpose output
TINP0 C6 I IPD Timer 0 or general-purpose input
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
IPD = Internal pulldown, IPU = Internal pullup. (These IPD/IPU signal pins feature a 30-k IPD or IPU resistor. To pull up a signal to the opposite
supply rail, a 1-kresistor should be used.)
§For the C6415 and C6416 devices, these pins are multiplexed pins. For more details, see the Device Configurations section of this data sheet.
The C6414 device does not support the PCI or UTOPIA peripherals; therefore, these muxed peripheral pins are standalone peripheral functions
for this device.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
56 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
IPU
DESCRIPTION
UNIVERSAL TEST AND OPERATIONS PHY INTERFACE FOR ASYNCHRONOUS TRANSFER MODE (ATM) [UTOPIA SLAVE]
[C6415 and C6416 devices only]
UTOPIA SLAVE (ATM CONTROLLER) − TRANSMIT INTERFACE
UXCLKYAD11 I Source clock for UTOPIA transmit driven by Master ATM Controller.
When the UTOPIA peripheral is disabled (UTOPIA_EN [BEA11 pin] = 0), this pin is tied-off.
UXCLAVYAC14 O/Z
Transmit cell available status output signal from UTOPIA Slave.
0 indicates a complete cell is NOT available for transmit
1 indicates a complete cell is available for transmit
When the UTOPIA peripheral is disabled (UTOPIA_EN [BEA11 pin] = 0), this pin is tied-off.
UXENBYAE15 I
UTOPIA transmit interface enable input signal. Asserted by the Master ATM Controller to indi-
cate that the UTOPIA Slave should put out on the Transmit Data Bus the first byte of valid data
and the UXSOC signal in the next clock cycle.
When the UTOPIA peripheral is disabled (UTOPIA_EN [BEA11 pin] = 0), this pin is tied-off.
UXSOCYAC13 O/Z
Transmit Start-of-Cell signal. This signal is output by the UTOPIA Slave on the rising edge of
the UXCLK, indicating that the first valid byte of the cell is available on the 8-bit T ransmit Data
Bus (UXDATA[7:0]).
When the UTOPIA peripheral is disabled (UTOPIA_EN [BEA11 pin] = 0), this pin is tied-off.
DX1/
UXADDR4§AB11 I/O/Z
McBSP1 [default] or UTOPIA transmit address pins
As UTOPIA transmit address pins UXADDR[4:0] (I), UTOPIA_EN (BEA11 pin) = 1:
5-bit Slave transmit address input pins driven by the Master ATM Controller to identify and
select one of the Slave devices (up to 31 possible) in the ATM System.
UXADDR0 pin is tied off when the UTOPIA peripheral is disabled [UTOPIA_EN
(BEA11 pin) = 0]
For the McBSP1 pin functions (UTOPIA_EN (BEA11 pin) = 0 [default]), see the MULTICHAN-
NEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT 1 (McBSP1) section of this table.
FSX1/
UXADDR3§AB13 I/O/Z McBSP1 [default] or UTOPIA transmit address pins
As UTOPIA transmit address pins UXADDR[4:0] (I), UTOPIA_EN (BEA11 pin) = 1:
FSR1/
UXADDR2§AC9 I/O/Z
As UTOPIA transmit address pins UXADDR[4:0] (I), UTOPIA_EN (BEA11 pin) = 1:
5-bit Slave transmit address input pins driven by the Master ATM Controller to identify and
select one of the Slave devices (up to 31 possible) in the ATM System.
DR1/
UXADDR1§AF11 I
UXADDR0 pin is tied off when the UTOPIA peripheral is disabled [UTOPIA_EN
(BEA11 pin) = 0]
For the McBSP1 pin functions (UTOPIA_EN (BEA11 pin) = 0 [default]), see the MULTICHAN-
UXADDR0YAE9 I For the McBSP1 pin functions (UTOPIA_EN (BEA11 pin) = 0 [default]), see the MULTICHAN
-
NEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT 1 (McBSP1) section of this table.
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
IPD = Internal pulldown, IPU = Internal pullup. (These IPD/IPU signal pins feature a 30-k IPD or IPU resistor. To pull up a signal to the opposite
supply rail, a 1-kresistor should be used.)
§For the C6415 and C6416 devices, these pins are multiplexed pins. For more details, see the Device Configurations section of this data sheet.
The C6414 device does not support the PCI or UTOPIA peripherals; therefore, these muxed peripheral pins are standalone peripheral functions
for this device.
For the C6415 and C6416 devices, external pulldowns required: If UTOPIA is selected (BEA11 = 1 ) and these pins are connected to other devices,
then a 10-kresistor must be used to externally pull down each of these pins. If these pins are “no connects”, then only UXCLK and URCLK
need to be pulled down and other pulldowns are not necessary.
For the C6415 and C6416 devices, external pullups required: If UTOPIA is selected (BEA11 = 1) and these pins are connected to other devices,
then a 10-kresistor must be used to externally pull up each of these pins. If these pins are “no connects”, then the pullups are not necessary.
ΨThe C6414 device does not support the UTOPIA peripheral; therefore, these standalone UTOPIA pins are Reserved (leave unconnected, do
not connect to power or ground) with the exception of UXCLK and URCLK which should be connected to a 10-kpulldown resistor (see the
square [] footnote).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
57
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
IPU
DESCRIPTION
UTOPIA SLAVE (ATM CONTROLLER) − TRANSMIT INTERFACE (CONTINUED)
UXDATA7YAD10
UXDATA6YAD9
UXDATA5YAD8 8-bit Transmit Data Bus
Using the Transmit Data Bus, the UTOPIA Slave (on the rising edge of the UXCLK) transmits
UXDATA4YAE8
8-bit Transmit Data Bus
Using the Transmit Data Bus, the UTOPIA Slave (on the rising edge of the UXCLK) transmit
s
the 8-bit ATM cells to the Master ATM Controller.
UXDATA3YAF9 O/Z
the 8-bit ATM cells to the Master ATM Controller.
When the UTOPIA peripheral is disabled (UTOPIA_EN [BEA11 pin] = 0), these pins are tied-
UXDATA2YAF7
When the UTOPIA peripheral is disabled (UTOPIA_EN [BEA11 pin] = 0), these pins are tied-
off.
UXDATA1YAE7
off.
UXDATA0YAD7
UTOPIA SLAVE (ATM CONTROLLER) − RECEIVE INTERFACE
URCLKYAD12 I Source clock for UTOPIA receive driven by Master ATM Controller.
When the UTOPIA peripheral is disabled (UTOPIA_EN [BEA11 pin] = 0), this pin is tied-off.
URCLAVYAF14 O/Z
Receive cell available status output signal from UTOPIA Slave.
0 indicates NO space is available to receive a cell from Master ATM Controller
1 indicates space is available to receive a cell from Master ATM Controller
When the UTOPIA peripheral is disabled (UTOPIA_EN [BEA11 pin] = 0), this pin is tied-off.
URENBYAD15 I
UTOPIA receive interface enable input signal. Asserted by the Master ATM Controller to indi-
cate t o the UT OPIA Slave to sample the Receive Data Bus (URDATA[7:0]) and URSOC signal
in the next clock cycle or thereafter.
When the UTOPIA peripheral is disabled (UTOPIA_EN [BEA11 pin] = 0), this pin is tied-off.
URSOCYAB14 I
Receive Start-of-Cell signal. This signal is output by the Master ATM Controller to indicate to
the UT OPIA Slave that the first valid byte of the cell is available to sample on the 8-bit Receive
Data Bus (URDATA[7:0]).
When the UTOPIA peripheral is disabled (UTOPIA_EN [BEA11 pin] = 0), this pin is tied-off.
CLKX1/
URADDR4§AB12 I/O/Z McBSP1 [default] or UTOPIA receive address pins
As UTOPIA receive address pins URADDR[4:0] (I), UTOPIA_EN (BEA11 pin) = 1:
CLKS1/
URADDR3§AC8 I
As UTOPIA receive address pins URADDR[4:0] (I), UTOPIA_EN (BEA11 pin) = 1:
5-bit Slave receive address input pins driven by the Master ATM Controller to identify and
select one of the Slave devices (up to 31 possible) in the ATM System.
CLKR1/
URADDR2§AC10 I/O/Z
select one of the Slave devices (up to 31 possible) in the ATM System.
URADDR1 and URADDR0 pins are tied off when the UTOPIA peripheral is disabled
[UTOPIA_EN (BEA11 pin) = 0]
URADDR1YAF10 I
[UTOPIA_EN (BEA11 pin) = 0]
For the McBSP1 pin functions (UTOPIA_EN (BEA11 pin) = 0 [default]), see the MULTICHAN-
URADDR0YAE10 I
For the McBSP1 pin functions (UTOPIA_EN (BEA11 pin) = 0 [default]), see the MULTICHAN-
NEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT 1 (McBSP1) section of this table.
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
IPD = Internal pulldown, IPU = Internal pullup. (These IPD/IPU signal pins feature a 30-k IPD or IPU resistor. To pull up a signal to the opposite
supply rail, a 1-kresistor should be used.)
§These pins are multiplexed pins. For more details, see the Device Configurations section of this data sheet.
External pulldowns required: If UTOPIA is selected (BEA11 = 1) and these pins are connected to other devices, then a 10-kresistor must be
used t o externally pull down each of these pins. If these pins are “no connects”, then only UXCLK and URCLK need to be pulled down and other
pulldowns are not necessary.
External pullups required: If UTOPIA is selected (BEA11 = 1) and these pins are connected to other devices, then a 10-kresistor must be used
to externally pull up each of these pins. If these pins are “no connects”, then the pullups are not necessary.
ΨThe C6414 device does not support the UTOPIA peripheral; therefore, these standalone UTOPIA pins are Reserved (leave unconnected, do
not connect to power or ground) with the exception of UXCLK and URCLK which should be connected to a 10-kpulldown resistor (see the
square [] footnote).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
58 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
IPU
DESCRIPTION
UTOPIA SLAVE (ATM CONTROLLER) − RECEIVE INTERFACE (CONTINUED)
URDATA7YAF12
URDATA6YAE11
URDATA5YAF13 8-bit Receive Data Bus.
Using the Receive Data Bus, the UT OPIA Slave (on the rising edge of the URCLK) can receive
URDATA4YAC11
8-bit Receive Data Bus.
Using the Receive Data Bus, the UT OPIA Slave (on the rising edge of the URCLK) can receive
the 8-bit ATM cell data from the Master ATM Controller.
URDATA3YAC12 I
the 8-bit ATM cell data from the Master ATM Controller.
When the UTOPIA peripheral is disabled (UTOPIA_EN [BEA11 pin] = 0), these pins are tied-
URDATA2YAE12
When the UTOPIA peripheral is disabled (UTOPIA_EN [BEA11 pin] = 0), these pins are tied-
off.
URDATA1YAD14
off.
URDATA0YAD13
RESERVED FOR TEST
G14
H7
RSV N20 Reserved. These pins must be connected directly to CV
DD
for proper device operation.
RSV
P7
Reserved. These pins must be connected directly to CVDD for proper device operation.
Y13
RSV R6 Reserved. This pin must be connected directly to DVDD for proper device operation.
A3
G2
H3
RSV
J4
Reserved (leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground)
RSV K6 Reserved (leave unconnected,
do not
connect to power or ground)
N3
P3
W25 IPD
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
IPD = Internal pulldown, IPU = Internal pullup. (These IPD/IPU signal pins feature a 30-k IPD or IPU resistor. To pull up a signal to the opposite
supply rail, a 1-kresistor should be used.)
External pulldowns required: If UTOPIA is selected (BEA11 = 1) and these pins are connected to other devices, then a 10-kresistor must be
used t o externally pull down each of these pins. If these pins are “no connects”, then only UXCLK and URCLK need to be pulled down and other
pulldowns are not necessary.
ΨThe C6414 device does not support the UTOPIA peripheral; therefore, these standalone UTOPIA pins are Reserved (leave unconnected, do
not connect to power or ground) with the exception of UXCLK and URCLK which should be connected to a 10-kpulldown resistor (see the
square [] footnote).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
59
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
DESCRIPTION
SUPPLY VOLTAGE PINS
A2
A25
B1
B14
B26
E7
E8
E10
E17
E19
E20
F3
F9
F12
F15
F18
G5
G22
H5
DVDD
H22
3.3-V supply voltage
DVDD J21 S
3.3-V supply voltage
(see the Power-Supply Decoupling section of this data sheet)
K5
(see the Power-Supply Decoupling section of this data sheet)
K22
L5
M5
M6
M21
N2
P25
R5
R21
T5
U5
U22
V6
V21
W5
W22
Y5
Y22
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
60 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
DESCRIPTION
SUPPLY VOLTAGE PINS (CONTINUED)
AA9
AA12
AA15
AA18
AB7
AB8
AB10
3.3-V supply voltage
DV
DD
AB17 3.3-V supply voltage
(see the Power-Supply Decoupling section of this data sheet)
DVDD
AB19
(see the Power-Supply Decoupling section of this data sheet)
AB20
AE1
AE13
AE26
AF2
AF25
A1
A26
B2
B25
C3 S
C24
D4
D23
E5
E22
F6
1.2-V supply voltage (-5E0 device)
CVDD
F7
1.2-V supply voltage (-5E0 device)
1.25-V supply voltage (A-5E0 device)
CVDD F20
1.25-V supply voltage (A-5E0 device)
1.4 V supply voltage (-6E3, A-6E3, -7E3 devices)
(see the Power-Supply Decoupling section of this data sheet)
F21
1.4 V supply voltage (-6E3, A-6E3, -7E3 devices)
(see the Power-Supply Decoupling section of this data sheet)
G6
G7
G8
G10
G11
G13
G16
G17
G19
G20
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
61
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
DESCRIPTION
SUPPLY VOLTAGE PINS (CONTINUED)
G21
H20
K7
K20
L7
L20
N7
P20
T7
T20
U7
U20
W7
W20
Y6
Y7
Y8
Y10
Y11 1.2-V supply voltage (-5E0 device)
1.25-V supply voltage (A-5E0 device)
CV
DD
Y14 S
1.2-V supply voltage (-5E0 device)
1.25-V supply voltage (A-5E0 device)
1.4 V supply voltage (-6E3, A-6E3, -7E3 devices)
CVDD
Y16
1.4 V supply voltage (-6E3, A-6E3, -7E3 devices)
(see the Power-Supply Decoupling section of this data sheet)
Y17
(see the Power-Supply Decoupling section of this data sheet)
Y19
Y20
Y21
AA6
AA7
AA20
AA21
AB5
AB22
AC4
AC23
AD3
AD24
AE2
AE25
AF1
AF26
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
62 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
DESCRIPTION
GROUND PINS
A8
A19
B3
B13
B24
C2
C4
C23
C25
D3
D5
D22
D24
E4
E6
E9
E18
E21
E23
V
SS
F5 GND Ground pins
VSS
F8
Ground pins
F10
F11
F13
F14
F16
F17
F19
F22
G9
G12
G15
G18
H1
H6
H21
H26
J5
J7
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
63
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
DESCRIPTION
GROUND PINS (CONTINUED)
J20
J22
K21
L6
L21
M7
M20
N6
N21
N25
P2
P6
P21
R7
R20
T6
T21
U6
U21
V
SS
V5 GND Ground pins
VSS
V7
Ground pins
V20
V22
W1
W6
W21
W26
Y9
Y12
Y15
Y18
AA5
AA8
AA10
AA11
AA13
AA14
AA16
AA17
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
64 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Terminal Functions (Continued)
SIGNAL
DESCRIPTION
NAME NO.
DESCRIPTION
GROUND PINS (CONTINUED)
AA19
AA22
AB4
AB6
AB9
AB18
AB21
AB23
AC3
AC5
V
SS
AC22 GND Ground pins
VSS
AC24
Ground pins
AD2
AD4
AD23
AD25
AE3
AE14
AE24
AF8
AF19
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High impedance, S = Supply voltage, GND = Ground
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
65
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
development support
TI offers an extensive line of development tools for the TMS320C6000 DSP platform, including tools to
evaluate the performance of the processors, generate code, develop algorithm implementations, and fully
integrate and debug software and hardware modules.
The following products support development of C6000 DSP-based applications:
Software Development Tools:
Code Composer Studio Integrated Development Environment (IDE): including Editor
C/C++/Assembly Code Generation, and Debug plus additional development tools
Scalable, Real-Time Foundation Software (DSP/BIOS), which provides the basic run-time target software
needed to support any DSP application.
Hardware Development Tools:
Extended Development System (XDS) Emulator (supports C6000 DSP multiprocessor system debug)
EVM (Evaluation Module)
For a complete listing of development-support tools for the TMS320C6000 DSP platform, visit the Texas
Instruments web site on the Worldwide Web at http://www.ti.com uniform resource locator (URL). For
information on pricing and availability, contact the nearest TI field sales office or authorized distributor.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
Code Composer Studio, DSP/BIOS, and XDS are trademarks of Texas Instruments.
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
66 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
device support
device and development-support tool nomenclature
To designate the stages in the product development cycle, TI assigns prefixes to the part numbers of all
TMS320 DSP devices and support tools. Each TMS320 DSP commercial family member has one of three
prefixes: TMX, TMP, or TMS. Texas Instruments recommends two of three possible prefix designators for its
support tools: TMDX and TMDS. These prefixes represent evolutionary stages of product development from
engineering prototypes (TMX/TMDX) through fully qualified production devices/tools (TMS/TMDS).
Device development evolutionary flow:
TMX Experimental device that is not necessarily representative of the final device’s electrical
specifications
TMP Final silicon die that conforms to the device’s electrical specifications but has not completed
quality and reliability verification
TMS Fully qualified production device
Support tool development evolutionary flow:
TMDX Development-support product that has not yet completed Texas Instruments internal qualification
testing.
TMDS Fully qualified development-support product
TMX and TMP devices and TMDX development-support tools are shipped against the following disclaimer:
“Developmental product is intended for internal evaluation purposes.”
TMS devices and TMDS development-support tools have been characterized fully, and the quality and reliability
of the device have been demonstrated fully. TI’s standard warranty applies.
Predictions show that prototype devices (TMX or TMP) have a greater failure rate than the standard production
devices. Texas Instruments recommends that these devices not be used in any production system because their
expected end-use failure rate still is undefined. Only qualified production devices are to be used.
TI device nomenclature also includes a suffix with the device family name. This suffix indicates the package type
(for example, GLZ), the temperature range (for example, blank is the default commercial temperature range),
and the device speed range in megahertz (for example, -6E3 is 600-MHz CPU, 133-MHz EMIFA). Figure 5
provides a legend for reading the complete device name for any TMS320C64x DSP generation member.
The ZLZ package, like the GLZ package, is a 532-pin plastic BGA only with lead-free balls. The ZLZ package
type is available upon request. For device part numbers and further ordering information for
TMS320C6414/C6415/C6416 in the GLZ and ZLZ package types, see the TI website (http://www.ti.com) or
contact your TI sales representative.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
TMS320 is a trademark of Texas Instruments.
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
67
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
C64x DSP:
6411
6414E 6414D 6414C
6415E 6415D 6415C
6416E 6416D 6416C
PREFIX DEVICE SPEED RANGE
TMS 32 C 6415E GLZ 6E3
TMX= Experimental device
TMP= Prototype device
TMS= Qualified device
SMX= Experimental device, MIL
SMJ = MIL-PRF-38535, QML
SM = High Rel (non-38535)
DEVICE FAMILY
3 or 32 or 320 = TMS320 DSP family
TECHNOLOGY
PACKAGE TYPE§
GLZ = 532-pin plastic BGA
ZLZ = 532-pin plastic BGA, with lead-free balls
C = CMOS DEVICE
See the Recommended Operating Conditions section of this data sheet for more details.
The extended temperature “A version” devices may have different operating conditions than the commercial temperature devices.
See the Recommended Operating Conditions section of this data sheet for more details.
§BGA= Ball Grid Array
For the actual device part numbers (P/Ns) and ordering information, see the TI website (www.ti.com).
TEMPERATURE RANGE (DEFAULT: 0°C TO 90°C)
( )
Blank = 0°C to 90°C, commercial temperature
A = −40°C to 105°C, extended temperature
300
5E0 (500-MHz CPU, 100-MHz EMIF)
6E3 (600-MHz CPU, 133-MHz EMIFA)
7E3 (720-MHz CPU, 133-MHz EMIFA)
Figure 5. TMS320C64x DSP Device Nomenclature (Including the C6414, C6415, and C6416 Devices)
For additional information, see the TMS320C6414, TMS320C6415, and TMS320C6416 Digital Signal
Processors Silicon Errata (literature number SPRZ011)
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
68 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
documentation support
Extensive documentation supports all TMS320 DSP family generations of devices from product
announcement through applications development. The types of documentation available include: data sheets,
such as this document, with design specifications; complete user’s reference guides for all devices and tools;
technical briefs; development-support tools; on-line help; and hardware and software applications. The
following is a brief, descriptive list of support documentation specific to the C6000 DSP devices:
The TMS320C6000 CPU and Instruction Set Reference Guide (literature number SPRU189) describes the
C6000 DSP CPU (core) architecture, instruction set, pipeline, and associated interrupts.
The TMS320C6000 DSP Peripherals Overview Reference Guide (literature number SPRU190) provides an
overview and briefly describes the functionality of the peripherals available on the C6000 DSP platform of
devices. This document also includes a table listing the peripherals available on the C6000 devices along with
literature numbers and hyperlinks to the associated peripheral documents.
The TMS320C64x Technical Overview (literature number SPRU395) gives an introduction to the C64x digital
signal processor, and discusses the application areas that are enhanced by the C64x DSP V elociTI.2 VLIW
architecture.
The TMS320C6414, TMS320C6415, and TMS320C6416 Digital Signal Processors Silicon Errata (literature
number SPRZ011) describes the known exceptions to the functional specifications for the TMS320C6414,
TMS320C6415, and TMS320C6416 devices.
The TMS320C6414/15/16 Power Consumption Summary application report (literature number SPRA811)
discusses the power consumption for user applications with the TMS320C6414, TMS320C6415, and
TMS320C6416 DSP devices.
The Using IBIS Models for Timing Analysis application report (literature number SPRA839) describes how to
properly use IBIS models to attain accurate timing analysis for a given system.
The How To Begin Development Today With the TMS320C6414, TMS320C6415, and TMS320C6416 DSPs
application report (literature number SPRA718) describes in more detail the compatibility and
similarities/differences among the C6414, C6415, C6416, and C6211 devices.
The tools support documentation is electronically available within the Code Composer Studio Integrated
Development Environment (IDE). For a complete listing of C6000 DSP latest documentation, visit the Texas
Instruments web site on the Worldwide Web at http://www.ti.com uniform resource locator (URL).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
69
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
clock PLL
Most of the internal C64x DSP clocks are generated from a single source through the CLKIN pin. This source
clock either drives the PLL, which multiplies the source clock frequency to generate the internal CPU clock, or
bypasses the PLL to become the internal CPU clock.
To use the PLL to generate the CPU clock, the external PLL filter circuit must be properly designed. Figure 6
shows the external PLL circuitry for either x1 (PLL bypass) or other PLL multiply modes.
To minimize the clock jitter, a single clean power supply should power both the C64x DSP device and the
external clock oscillator circuit. The minimum CLKIN rise and fall times should also be observed. For the input
clock timing requirements, see the input and output clocks electricals section.
Rise/fall times, duty cycles (high/low pulse durations), and the load capacitance of the external clock source
must meet the DSP requirements in this data sheet (see the electrical characteristics over recommended
ranges of supply voltage and operating case temperature table and the input and output clocks electricals
section). Table 30 lists some examples of compatible CLKIN external clock sources:
Table 30. Compatible CLKIN External Clock Sources
COMPATIBLE PARTS FOR
EXTERNAL CLOCK SOURCES (CLKIN) PART NUMBER MANUFACTURER
JITO-2 Fox Electronix
Oscillators
STA series, ST4100 series SaRonix Corporation
Oscillators SG-636 Epson America
342 Corning Frequency Control
PLL ICS525-02
Integrated Circuit Systems
Spread Spectrum Clock Generator MK1714 Integrated Circuit Systems
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
70 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
clock PLL (continued)
PLLMULT
1
0
PLLCLK
CLKMODE0
CLKMODE1
CLKIN
C2C1
EMI
filter
3.3 V
/2
/8
/4
/6
00 01 10
CPU Clock
Peripheral Bus
Timer Internal Clock
CLKOUT4,
McBSP Internal Clock
CLKOUT6
ECLKIN_SEL (DEVCFG.[17,16]
and DEVCFG.[15,14])
/2
/4
EMIF 00 01 10 EK2RATE
(GBLCTL.[19,18])
ECLKOUT2ECLKOUT1
PLL
x6, x12
10 µF 0.1 µF
ECLKIN
(For the PLL Options, CLKMODE Pins Setup, and
PLL Clock Frequency Ranges, see Table 31.)
Internal to C64x
PLLV
NOTES: A. Place all PLL external components (C1, C2, and the EMI Filter) as close to the C6000 DSP device as possible. For the best
performance, TI recommends that all the PLL external components be on a single side of the board without jumpers, switches, or
components other than the ones shown.
B. For reduced PLL jitter, maximize the spacing between switching signals and the PLL external components (C1, C2, and the EMI
Filter).
C. The 3.3-V supply for the EMI filter must be from the same 3.3-V power plane supplying the I/O voltage, DVDD.
D. EMI filter manufacturer TDK part number ACF451832-333, -223, -153, -103. Panasonic part number EXCCET103U.
Figure 6. External PLL Circuitry for Either PLL Multiply Modes or x1 (Bypass) Mode
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
71
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
clock PLL (continued)
Table 31. TMS320C64x PLL Multiply Factor Options, Clock Frequency Ranges, and Typical Lock Time†‡
GLZ and ZLZ PACKAGE − 23 x 23 mm BGA
CLKMODE1 CLKMODE0 CLKMODE
(PLL MULTIPLY
FACTORS)
CLKIN
RANGE
(MHz)
CPU CLOCK
FREQUENCY
RANGE (MHz)
CLKOUT4
RANGE (MHz) CLKOUT6
RANGE (MHz)
TYPICAL
LOCK TIME
(µs)§
0 0 Bypass (x1) 30−75.75 30−75.75 7.5−18.9 5−12.6 N/A
0 1 x6 30−75.75 180−454.5 45−113.6 30−75.75
75
1 0 x12 30−60.6 360−727.2 90−181.8 60−121.2 75
1 1 Reserved
These clock frequency range values are applicable to a C64x−6E3 speed device. For −5E0 and -7E3 device speed values, see the CLKIN timing
requirements table for the specific device speed.
Use external pullup resistors on the CLKMODE pins (CLKMODE1 and CLKMODE0) to set the C64x device to one of the valid PLL multiply clock
modes (x6 or x12). With internal pulldown resistors on the CLKMODE pins (CLKMODE1, CLKMODE0), the default clock mode is x1 (bypass).
§Under some operating conditions, the maximum PLL lock time may vary by as much as 150% from the specified typical value. For example, if
the typical lock time is specified as 100 µs, the maximum value may be as long as 250 µs.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
72 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
general-purpose input/output (GPIO)
To use the GP[15:0] software-configurable GPIO pins, the GPxEN bits in the GP Enable (GPEN) Register and
the GPxDIR bits in the GP Direction (GPDIR) Register must be properly configured.
GPxEN = 1 GP[x] pin is enabled
GPxDIR = 0 GP[x] pin is an input
GPxDIR = 1 GP[x] pin is an output
where “x” represents one of the 15 through 0 GPIO pins
Figure 7 shows the GPIO enable bits in the GPEN register for the C6414/C6415/C6416 device. To use any of
the GPx pins as general-purpose input/output functions, the corresponding GPxEN bit must be set to “1”
(enabled). Default values are device-specific, so refer to Figure 7 for the C6414/15/16 default configuration.
31 24 23 16
Reserved
R-0
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6543210
GP15
EN GP14
EN GP13
EN GP12
EN GP11
EN GP10
EN GP9
EN GP8
EN GP7
EN GP6
EN GP5
EN GP4
EN GP3
EN GP2
EN GP1
EN GP0
EN
R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-1
Legend: R/W = Readable/Writeable; -n = value after reset, -x = undefined value after reset
Figure 7. GPIO Enable Register (GPEN) [Hex Address: 01B0 0000]
Figure 8 shows the GPIO direction bits in the GPDIR register. This register determines if a given GPIO pin is
an input or an output providing the corresponding GPxEN bit is enabled (set to “1”) in the GPEN register. By
default, all the GPIO pins are configured as input pins.
31 24 23 16
Reserved
R-0
15 14 13 12 11 10 9876543210
GP15
DIR GP14
DIR GP13
DIR GP12
DIR GP11
DIR GP10
DIR GP9
DIR GP8
DIR GP7
DIR GP6
DIR GP5
DIR GP4
DIR GP3
DIR GP2
DIR GP1
DIR GP0
DIR
R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0
Legend: R/W = Readable/Writeable; -n = value after reset, -x = undefined value after reset
Figure 8. GPIO Direction Register (GPDIR) [Hex Address: 01B0 0004]
For more detailed information on general-purpose inputs/outputs (GPIOs), see the TMS320C6000 DSP
General-Purpose Input/Output (GPIO) Reference Guide (literature number SPRU584).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
73
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
power-down mode logic
Figure 9 shows the power-down mode logic on the C6414/C6415/C6416.
PWRD
Internal Clock Tree
CPU
IFR
IER
CSR
PD1
PD2
Power-
Down
Logic
Clock
PLL
CLKIN RESET
CLKOUT6
PD3
Internal
Peripherals
CLKOUT4
Clock
and Dividers
Distribution
External input clocks, with the exception of CLKIN, are not gated by the power-down mode logic.
TMS320C6414/15/16
Figure 9. Power-Down Mode Logic
triggering, wake-up, and effects
The power-down modes and their wake-up methods are programmed by setting the PWRD field (bits 15−10)
of the control status register (CSR). The PWRD field of the CSR is shown in Figure 10 and described in Table 32.
When writing to the CSR, all bits of the PWRD field should be set at the same time. Logic 0 should be used when
writing to the reserved bit (bit 15) of the PWRD field. The CSR is discussed in detail in the TMS320C6000 CPU
and Instruction Set Reference Guide (literature number SPRU189).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
74 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
31 16
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
Reserved Enable or
Non-Enabled
Interrupt Wake
Enabled
Interrupt Wake PD3 PD2 PD1
R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0
7 0
Legend: R/W−x = Read/write reset value
NOTE: The shadowed bits are not part of the power-down logic discussion and therefore are not covered here. For information on these other
bit fields in the CSR register, see the TMS320C6000 CPU and Instruction Set Reference Guide (literature number SPRU189).
Figure 10. PWRD Field of the CSR Register
A delay of up to nine cycles may occur after the instruction that sets the PWRD bits in the CSR before the PD
mode takes e f fect. A s b est practice, N OPs s hould b e padded a fter the P WRD b its a re s et in t he C SR t o a ccount
for this delay.
If PD1 mode is terminated by a non-enabled interrupt, the program execution returns to the instruction where
PD1 took effect. If PD1 mode is terminated by an enabled interrupt, the interrupt service routine will be executed
first, then the program execution returns to the instruction where PD1 took effect. In the case with an enabled
interrupt, the GIE bit in the CSR and the NMIE bit in the interrupt enable register (IER) must also be set in order
for the interrupt service routine to execute; otherwise, execution returns to the instruction where PD1 took effect
upon PD1 mode termination by an enabled interrupt.
PD2 and PD3 modes can only be aborted by device reset. Table 32 summarizes all the power-down modes.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
75
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
Table 32. Characteristics of the Power-Down Modes
PRWD FIELD
(BITS 15−10) POWER-DOWN
MODE WAKE-UP METHOD EFFECT ON CHIP’S OPERATION
000000 No power-down
001001 PD1 Wake by an enabled interrupt CPU halted (except for the interrupt logic)
Power-down mode blocks the internal clock inputs at the
010001 PD1 Wake by an enabled or
non-enabled interrupt
Power-down mode blocks the internal clock inputs at the
boundary of the CPU, preventing most of the CPU’s logic from
switching. During PD1, EDMA transactions can proceed
between peripherals and internal memory.
011010 PD2Wake by a device reset
Output clock from PLL is halted, stopping the internal clock
structure from switching and resulting in the entire chip being
halted. All register and internal RAM contents are preserved. All
functional I/O “freeze” in the last state when the PLL clock is
turned off.
011100 PD3Wake by a device reset
Input clock to the PLL stops generating clocks. All register and
internal RAM contents are preserved. All functional I/O “freeze” in
the last state w hen t he P LL clock i s turned o f f. Following reset, the
PLL needs time to re-lock, just as it does following power-up.
Wake-up from PD3 takes longer than wake-up from PD2 because
the PLL needs to be re-locked, just as it does following power-up.
All others Reserved
When entering PD2 and PD3, all functional I/O remains in the previous state. However, for peripherals which are asynchronous in nature or
peripherals with an external clock source, output signals may transition in response to stimulus on the inputs. Under these conditions,
peripherals will not operate according to specifications.
C64x power-down mode with an emulator
If user power-down modes are programmed, and an emulator is attached, the modes will be masked to allow
the emulator access to the system. This condition prevails until the emulator is reset or the cable is removed
from th e h e a d e r. If power measurements are to be performed when in a power-down mode, the emulator cable
should be removed.
When the DSP is in power-down mode PD2 or PD3, emulation logic will force any emulation execution
command (such as Step or Run) to spin in IDLE. For this reason, PC writes (such as loading code) will fail. A DSP
reset will be required to get the DSP out of PD2/PD3.
power-supply sequencing
TI DSPs do not require specific power sequencing between the core supply and the I/O supply. However,
systems should be designed to ensure that neither supply is powered up for extended periods of time
(>1 second) if the other supply is below the proper operating voltage.
power-supply design considerations
A dual-power supply with simultaneous sequencing can be used to eliminate the delay between core and I/O
power up. A Schottky diode can also be used to tie the core rail to the I/O rail (see Figure 11).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
76 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
DVDD
CVDD
VSS
C6000
DSP
Schottky
Diode
I/O Supply
Core Supply
GND
Figure 11. Schottky Diode Diagram
Core and I/O supply voltage regulators should be located close to the DSP (or DSP array) to minimize
inductance and resistance in the power delivery path. Additionally, when designing for high-performance
applications utilizing the C6000 platform of DSPs, the PC board should include separate power planes for
core, I/O, and ground, all bypassed with high-quality low-ESL/ESR capacitors.
power-supply decoupling
In order to properly decouple the supply planes from system noise, place as many capacitors (caps) as possible
close to the DSP. Assuming 0603 caps, the user should be able to fit a total of 60 caps, 30 for the core supply
and 30 for the I/O supply. These caps need to be close to the DSP power pins, no more than 1.25 cm maximum
distance to be effective. Physically smaller caps, such as 0402, are better because of their lower parasitic
inductance. Proper capacitance values are also important. Small bypass caps (near 560 pF) should be closest
to the power pins. Medium bypass caps (220 nF or as large as can be obtained in a small package) should be
next closest. TI recommends no less than 8 small and 8 medium caps per supply (32 total) be placed
immediately next to the BGA vias, using the “interior” BGA space and at least the corners of the “exterior”.
Eight larger caps (4 for each supply) can be placed further away for bulk decoupling. Large bulk caps (on the
order of 100 µF) should be furthest away (but still as close as possible). No less than 4 large caps per supply
(8 total) should be placed outside of the BGA.
Any cap selection needs to be evaluated from a yield/manufacturing point-of-view. As with the selection of any
component, verification of capacitor availability over the product’s production lifetime should be considered.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
77
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
IEEE 1149.1 JTAG compatibility statement
The TMS320C6414/15/16 DSP requires that both TRST and RESET be asserted upon power up to be properly
initialized. While RESET initializes the DSP core, TRST initializes the DSP’s emulation logic. Both resets are
required for proper operation.
Note: TRST is synchronous and must be clocked by TCLK; otherwise, BSCAN may not respond as expected
after TRST is asserted.
While both TRST and RESET need to be asserted upon power up, only RESET needs to be released for the
DSP to boot properly. TRST may be asserted indefinitely for normal operation, keeping the JTAG port interface
and DSP’ s emulation logic in the reset state. TRST only needs to be released when it is necessary to use a JTAG
controller to debug the DSP or exercise the DSP’s boundary scan functionality. RESET must be released in
order for boundary-scan JTAG to read the variant field of IDCODE correctly. Other boundary-scan instructions
work correctly independent of current state of RESET.
For maximum reliability, the TMS320C6414/15/16 DSP includes an internal pulldown (IPD) on the TRST pin
to ensure that TRST will always be asserted upon power up and the DSP’s internal emulation logic will always
be properly initialized. JTAG controllers from Texas Instruments actively drive TRST high. However, some
third-party JTAG controllers may not drive TRST high but expect the use of a pullup resistor on TRST. When
using this type of JTAG controller, assert TRST to intialize the DSP after powerup and externally drive TRST
high before attempting any emulation or boundary scan operations.
Following the release of RESET, the low-to-high transition of TRST must occur to latch the state of EMU1 and
EMU0. The EMU[1:0] pins configure the device for either Boundary Scan mode or Normal/Emulation mode. For
more detailed information, see the terminal functions section of this data sheet.
Note: The DESIGN_WARNING section of the TMS320C6414/15/16 BSDL file contains information and
constraints regarding proper device operation while in Boundary Scan Mode.
EMIF device speed
The rated EMIF speed, referring to both EMIFA and EMIFB, of these devices only applies to the SDRAM
interface when in a system that meets the following requirements:
1 chip-enable (CE) space (maximum of 2 chips) of SDRAM connected to EMIF
up to 1 CE space of buffers connected to EMIF
EMIF trace lengths between 1 and 3 inches
166-MHz SDRAM for 133-MHz operation (applies only to EMIFA)
143-MHz SDRAM for 100-MHz operation
Other configurations may be possible, but timing analysis must be done to verify all AC timings are met.
Verification of AC timings is mandatory when using configurations other than those specified above. TI
recommends utilizing I/O buffer information specification (IBIS) to analyze all AC timings.
To properly use IBIS models to attain accurate timing analysis for a given system, see the Using IBIS Models
for Timing Analysis application report (literature number SPRA839).
To maintain signal integrity, serial termination resistors should be inserted into all EMIF output signal lines (see
the Terminal Functions table for the EMIF output signals).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
78 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
bootmode
The C6414/15/16 device resets using the active-low signal RESET. While RESET is low, the device is held in
reset and is initialized to the prescribed reset state. Refer to reset timing for reset timing characteristics and
states of device pins during reset. The release of RESET starts the processor running with the prescribed device
configuration and boot mode.
The C6414/C6415/C6416 has three types of boot modes:
Host boot
If host boot is selected, upon release of RESET, the CPU is internally “stalled” while the remainder of the
device is released. During this period, an external host can initialize the CPU’ s memory space as necessary
through the host interface, including internal configuration registers, such as those that control the EMIF or
other peripherals. For the C6414 device, the HPI peripheral is used for host boot. For the C6415/C6416
device, the HPI peripheral is used for host boot if PCI_EN = 0, and the PCI peripheral is used for host boot if
PCI_EN = 1 . Once the host is finished with all necessary initialization, it must set the DSPINT bit in the HPIC
register to complete the boot process. This transition causes the boot configuration logic to bring the CPU
out of the “stalled” state. The CPU then begins execution from address 0. The DSPINT condition is not
latched by the CPU, because it occurs while the CPU is still internally “stalled”. Also, DSPINT brings the CPU
out of the “stalled” state only if the host boot process is selected. All memory may be written to and read by
the host. This allows for the host to verify what it sends to the DSP if required. After the CPU is out of the
“stalled” state, the CPU needs to clear the DSPINT, otherwise, no more DSPINTs can be received.
EMIF boot (using default ROM timings)
Upon the release of RESET, the 1K-Byte ROM code located in the beginning o f CE 1 is copied to address 0
by the EDMA using the default ROM timings, while the CPU is internally “stalled”. The data should be stored
in the endian format that the system is using. In this case, the EMIF automatically assembles consecutive
8-bit bytes to form the 32-bit instruction words to be copied. The transfer is automatically done by the EDMA
as a single-frame block transfer from the ROM to address 0. After completion of the block transfer, the CPU
is released from the “stalled” state and starts running from address 0.
No boot
With no boot, the CPU begins direct execution from the memory located at address 0. Note: operation is
undefined if invalid code is located at address 0.
reset
A hardware reset (RESET) is required to place the DSP into a known good state out of power-up. The RESET
signal can be asserted (pulled low) prior to ramping the core and I/O voltages or after the core and I/O voltages
have reached their proper operating conditions. As a best practice, reset should be held low during power-up.
Prior to deasserting RESET (low-to-high transition), the core and I/O voltages should be at their proper
operating conditions and CLKIN should also be running at the correct frequency.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
79
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
absolute maximum ratings over operating case temperature range (unless otherwise noted)
Supply voltage ranges: CVDD (see Note 1) − 0.3 V to 1.8 V. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
DVDD (see Note 1) −0.3 V to 4 V. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Input voltage ranges: (except PCI), VI−0.3 V to 4 V. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(PCI), VIP [C6415 and C6416 only] −0.5 V to DVDD + 0.5 V. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Output voltage ranges: (except PCI), VO−0.3 V to 4 V. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(PCI), VOP [C6415 and C6416 only] −0.5 V to DVDD + 0.5 V. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Operating case temperature ranges, TC: (default) 0C to 90C. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(A version) [A-5E0, A-6E3] −40C to105C. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Storage temperature range, Tstg −65C to 150C. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Stresses beyond those listed under “absolute maximum ratings” may cause permanent damage to the device. These are stress ratings only, and
functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions beyond those indicated under “recommended operating conditions” is not
implied. Exposure to absolute-maximum-rated conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability.
NOTE 1: All voltage values are with respect to VSS.
recommended operating conditions
MIN NOM MAX UNIT
CVDD Supply voltage, Core (-5E0 device)1.14 1.2 1.26 V
CVDD Supply voltage, Core (A-5E0 device)1.19 1.25 1.31 V
CVDD Supply voltage, Core (-6E3, A-6E3, -7E3 devices)1.36 1.4 1.44 V
DVDD Supply voltage, I/O 3.14 3.3 3.46 V
VSS Supply ground 0 0 0 V
VIH High-level input voltage (except PCI) 2 V
VIL Low-level input voltage (except PCI) 0.8 V
VIP Input voltage (PCI) [C6415 and C6416 only] −0.5 DVDD + 0.5 V
VIHP High-level input voltage (PCI) [C6415 and C6416 only] 0.5DVDD DVDD + 0.5 V
VILP Low-level input voltage (PCI) [C6415 and C6416 only] −0.5 0.3DVDD V
VOS Maximum voltage during overshoot/undershoot −1.0§4.3§V
Operating case tem-
perature
Default 0 90 C
C
Operating case tem-
perature A version (C6414/15/16GLZA-5E0 and GLZA-6E3 only) –40 105 C
Future variants of the C641x DSPs may operate at voltages ranging from 0.9 V to 1.4 V to provide a range of system power/performance options.
TI highly recommends that users design-in a supply that can handle multiple voltages within this range (i.e., 1.2 V, 1.25 V, 1.3 V, 1.35 V, 1.4 V
with ± 3 % tolerances) by implementing simple board changes such as reference resistor values or input pin configuration modifications . Examples
of such supplies include the PT4660, PT5500, PT5520, PT6440, and PT6930 series from Power Trends, a subsidiary of Texas Instruments. Not
incorporating a flexible supply may limit the system’s ability to easily adapt to future versions of C641x devices.
§The absolute maximum ratings should not be exceeded for more than 30% of the cycle period.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
80 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
electrical characteristics over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating case
temperature (unless otherwise noted)
PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONSMIN TYP MAX UNIT
VOH High-level output voltage (except PCI) DVDD = MIN, IOH = MAX 2.4 V
VOHP High-level output voltage (PCI)
[C6415/C6416 only] IOHP = −0.5 mA, DVDD = 3.3 V 0.9DVDDV
VOL Low-level output voltage (except PCI) DVDD = MIN, IOL = MAX 0.4 V
VOLP Low-level output voltage (PCI)
[C6415/C6416 only] IOLP = 1.5 mA, DVDD = 3.3 V 0.1DVDDV
VI = VSS to DVDD no opposing internal
resistor ±10 uA
IIInput current (except PCI) VI = VSS to DVDD opposing internal
pullup resistor50 100 150 uA
VI = VSS to DVDD opposing internal
pulldown resistor−150 −100 −50 uA
IIP Input leakage current (PCI)
[C6415/C6416 only]§0 < VIP < DVDD = 3.3 V ±10 uA
EMIF, CLKOUT4, CLKOUT6, EMUx −16 mA
IOH High-level output current Timer, UTOPIA, TDO, GPIO (Excluding
GP[15:9, 2, 1]), McBSP −8 mA
PCI/HPI −0.5mA
EMIF, CLKOUT4, CLKOUT6, EMUx 16 mA
IOL Low-level output current Timer, UTOPIA, TDO, GPIO (Excluding
GP[15:9, 2, 1]), McBSP 8 mA
PCI/HPI 1.5mA
IOZ Off-state output current VO = DVDD or 0 V ±10 uA
CVDD = 1.4 V, CPU clock = 720 MHz 900 mA
I
CDD
Core supply current#CVDD = 1.4 V, CPU clock = 600 MHz 750 mA
ICDD
Core supply current#
CVDD = 1.2 V, CPU clock = 500 MHz 550 mA
IDDD I/O supply current#DVDD = 3.3 V, CPU clock = 600 MHz 125 mA
CiInput capacitance 10 pF
CoOutput capacitance 10 pF
For test conditions shown as MIN, MAX, or NOM, use the appropriate value specified in the recommended operating conditions table.
Applies only to pins with an internal pullup (IPU) or pulldown (IPD) resistor.
§PCI input leakage currents include Hi-Z output leakage for all bidirectional buffers with 3-state outputs.
These rated numbers are from the PCI specification version 2.3. The DC specification and AC specification are defined in Tables 4-3 and 4-4,
respectively.
#Measured with average activity (50% high/50% low power). The actual current draw is highly application-dependent. For more details on core
and I/O activity, refer to the TMS320C6414/15/16 Power Consumption Summary application report (literature number SPRA811).
recommended clock and control signal transition behavior
All clocks and control signals must transition between VIH and VIL (or between VIL and VIH) in a monotonic
manner.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
81
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
PARAMETER MEASUREMENT INFORMATION
Transmission Line
4.0 pF 1.85 pF
Z0 = 50 W
(see note)
Tester Pin Electronics Data Sheet Timing Reference Point
Output
Under
Test
NOTE: The data sheet provides timing at the device pin. For output timing analysis, the tester pin electronics and its transmission line effects
must be taken into account. A transmission line with a delay of 2 ns or longer can be used to produce the desired transmission line ef fect.
The transmission line is intended as a load only. It is not necessary to add or subtract the transmission line delay (2 ns or longer) from
the data sheet timings.
42 W3.5 nH
Device Pin
(see note)
Input requirements in this data sheet are tested with an input slew rate of < 4 Volts per nanosecond (4 V/ns) at the device pin.
Figure 12. Test Load Circuit for AC Timing Measurements
The tester load circuit is for characterization and measurement of AC timing signals. This load does not indicate
the maximum load the device is capable of driving.
signal transition levels
All input and output timing parameters are referenced to 1.5 V for both “0” and “1” logic levels.
Vref = 1.5 V
Figure 13. Input and Output Voltage Reference Levels for AC Timing Measurements
All rise and fall transition timing parameters are referenced to VIL MAX and VIH MIN for input clocks, VOL MAX
and V OH MIN for output clocks, VILP MAX and VIHP MIN for PCI input clocks, and VOLP MAX and VOHP MIN for
PCI output clocks.
Vref = VIL MAX (or VOL MAX or
Vref = VIH MIN (or VOH MIN or
VIHP MIN or VOHP MIN)
VILP MAX or VOLP MAX)
Figure 14. Rise and Fall Transition Time Voltage Reference Levels
signal transition rates
All timings are tested with an input edge rate of 4 Volts per nanosecond (4 V/ns).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
82 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
PARAMETER MEASUREMENT INFORMATION (CONTINUED)
timing parameters and board routing analysis
The timing parameter values specified in this data sheet do not include delays by board routings. As a good
board design practice, such delays must always be taken into account. Timing values may be adjusted by
increasing/decreasing such delays. TI recommends utilizing the available I/O buffer information specification
(IBIS) models to analyze the timing characteristics correctly. If needed, external logic hardware such as buffers
may be used to compensate any timing differences.
For inputs, timing is most impacted by the round-trip propagation delay from the DSP to the external device and
from the external device to the DSP. This round-trip delay tends to negatively impact the input setup time margin,
but also tends to improve the input hold time margins (see Table 33 and Figure 15).
Figure 15 represents a general transfer between the DSP and an external device. The figure also represents
board route delays and how they are perceived by the DSP and the external device.
Table 33. Board-Level Timings Example (see Figure 15)
NO. DESCRIPTION
1Clock route delay
2Minimum DSP hold time
3Minimum DSP setup time
4External device hold time requirement
5External device setup time requirement
6Control signal route delay
7External device hold time
8External device access time
9DSP hold time requirement
10 DSP setup time requirement
11 Data route delay
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
10
11
ECLKOUTx
(Output from DSP)
ECLKOUTx
(Input to External Device)
Control Signals
(Output from DSP)
Control Signals
(Input to External Device)
Data Signals
(Output from External Device)
Data Signals
(Input to DSP)
9
Control signals include data for Writes.
Data signals are generated during Reads from an external device.
Figure 15. Board-Level Input/Output Timings
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
83
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
INPUT AND OUTPUT CLOCKS
timing requirements for CLKIN for −5E0 devices†‡§ (see Figure 16)
NO.
−5E0
A−5E0
UNIT
NO
.
PLL MODE x12 PLL MODE x6 x1 (BYPASS) UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX MIN MAX
1 tc(CLKIN) Cycle time, CLKIN 24 33.3 13.3 33.3 13.3 33.3 ns
2 tw(CLKINH) Pulse duration, CLKIN high 0.4C 0.4C 0.45C ns
3 tw(CLKINL) Pulse duration, CLKIN low 0.4C 0.4C 0.45C ns
4 tt(CLKIN) Transition time, CLKIN 5 5 1 ns
5 tJ(CLKIN) Period jitter, CLKIN 0.02C 0.02C 0.02C ns
The reference points for the rise and fall transitions are measured at VIL MAX and VIH MIN.
For more details on the PLL multiplier factors (x6, x12), see the Clock PLL section of this data sheet.
§C = CLKIN cycle time in ns. For example, when CLKIN frequency is 50 MHz, use C = 20 ns.
timing requirements for CLKIN for -6E3 devices†‡§ (see Figure 16)
−6E3, A−6E3
NO
.
PLL MODE x12 PLL MODE x6 x1 (BYPASS) UNIT
NO.
MIN MAX MIN MAX MIN MAX
UNIT
1 tc(CLKIN) Cycle time, CLKIN 20 33.3 13.3 33.3 13.3 33.3 ns
2 tw(CLKINH) Pulse duration, CLKIN high 0.4C 0.4C 0.45C ns
3 tw(CLKINL) Pulse duration, CLKIN low 0.4C 0.4C 0.45C ns
4 tt(CLKIN) Transition time, CLKIN 5 5 1 ns
5 tJ(CLKIN) Period jitter, CLKIN 0.02C 0.02C 0.02C ns
The reference points for the rise and fall transitions are measured at VIL MAX and VIH MIN.
For more details on the PLL multiplier factors (x6, x12), see the Clock PLL section of this data sheet.
§C = CLKIN cycle time in ns. For example, when CLKIN frequency is 50 MHz, use C = 20 ns.
timing requirements for CLKIN for -7E3 devices†‡§ (see Figure 16)
−7E3
NO
.
PLL MODE x12 PLL MODE x6 x1 (BYPASS) UNIT
NO.
MIN MAX MIN MAX MIN MAX
UNIT
1 tc(CLKIN) Cycle time, CLKIN 16.6 33.3 13.3 33.3 13.3 33.3 ns
2 tw(CLKINH) Pulse duration, CLKIN high 0.4C 0.4C 0.45C ns
3 tw(CLKINL) Pulse duration, CLKIN low 0.4C 0.4C 0.45C ns
4 tt(CLKIN) Transition time, CLKIN 5 5 1 ns
5 tJ(CLKIN) Period jitter, CLKIN 0.02C 0.02C 0.02C ns
The reference points for the rise and fall transitions are measured at VIL MAX and VIH MIN.
For more details on the PLL multiplier factors (x6, x12), see the Clock PLL section of this data sheet.
§C = CLKIN cycle time in ns. For example, when CLKIN frequency is 50 MHz, use C = 20 ns.
CLKIN
2
3
4
4
5
1
Figure 16. CLKIN Timing
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
84 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
INPUT AND OUTPUT CLOCKS (CONTINUED)
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for CLKOUT4†‡§
(see Figure 17)
NO.
PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3
UNIT
NO.
PARAMETER
CLKMODE = x1, x6, x12
UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tJ(CKO4) Period jitter, CLKOUT4 0±175 ps
2 tw(CKO4H) Pulse duration, CLKOUT4 high 2P − 0.7 2P + 0.7 ns
3 tw(CKO4L) Pulse duration, CLKOUT4 low 2P − 0.7 2P + 0.7 ns
4 tt(CKO4) Transition time, CLKOUT4 1 ns
The reference points for the rise and fall transitions are measured at VOL MAX and VOH MIN.
PH is the high period of CLKIN in ns and PL is the low period of CLKIN in ns.
§P = 1/CPU clock frequency in nanoseconds (ns)
CLKOUT4
3
4
4
2
1
Figure 17. CLKOUT4 Timing
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for CLKOUT6†‡§
(see Figure 18)
NO.
PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3
NO.
PARAMETER
CLKMODE = x1, x6, x12
MIN MAX
1 tJ(CKO6) Period jitter, CLKOUT6 0±175 ps
2 tw(CKO6H) Pulse duration, CLKOUT6 high 3P − 0.7 3P + 0.7 ns
3 tw(CKO6L) Pulse duration, CLKOUT6 low 3P − 0.7 3P + 0.7 ns
4 tt(CKO6) Transition time, CLKOUT6 1 ns
The reference points for the rise and fall transitions are measured at VOL MAX and VOH MIN.
PH is the high period of CLKIN in ns and PL is the low period of CLKIN in ns.
§P = 1/CPU clock frequency in nanoseconds (ns)
CLKOUT6
2
3
4
4
1
Figure 18. CLKOUT6 Timing
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
85
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
INPUT AND OUTPUT CLOCKS (CONTINUED)
timing requirements for ECLKIN for EMIFA and EMIFB†‡§¶ (see Figure 19)
NO
.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tc(EKI) Cycle time, ECLKIN 6#16P ns
2 tw(EKIH) Pulse duration, ECLKIN high 2.7 ns
3 tw(EKIL) Pulse duration, ECLKIN low 2.7 ns
4 tt(EKI) Transition time, ECLKIN 2 ns
5 tJ(EKI) Period jitter, ECLKIN 0.02E ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
The reference points for the rise and fall transitions are measured at VIL MAX and VIH MIN.
§These C64x devices have two EMIFs (64-bit EMIFA and 16-bit EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are
prefixed by a “B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted.
E = the EMIF input clock (ECLKIN, CPU/4 clock, or CPU/6 clock) period in ns for EMIFA or EMIFB.
#Minimum ECLKIN cycle times must be met, even when ECLKIN is generated by an internal clock source. Minimum ECLKIN times are based
on internal logic speed; the maximum useable speed of the EMIF may be lower due to AC timing requirements. On the 7E3 and 6E3 devices,
133-MHz operation is achievable if the requirements of the EMIF Device Speed section are met. On the 5E0 devices, 100-MHz operation is
achievable if the requirements of the EMIF Device Speed section are met.
ECLKIN
2
3
4
4
5
1
Figure 19. ECLKIN Timing for EMIFA and EMIFB
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for ECLKOUT1 for EMIFA and
EMIFB modules§¶|| (see Figure 20)
NO
.
PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tJ(EKO1) Period jitter, ECLKOUT1 0±175ps
2 tw(EKO1H) Pulse duration, ECLKOUT1 high EH − 0.7 EH + 0.7 ns
3 tw(EKO1L) Pulse duration, ECLKOUT1 low EL − 0.7 EL + 0.7 ns
4 tt(EKO1) Transition time, ECLKOUT1 1 ns
5 td(EKIH-EKO1H) Delay time, ECLKIN high to ECLKOUT1 high 1 8 ns
6 td(EKIL-EKO1L) Delay time, ECLKIN low to ECLKOUT1 low 1 8 ns
§These C64x devices have two EMIFs (64-bit EMIFA and 16-bit EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are
prefixed by a “B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted.
E = the EMIF input clock (ECLKIN, CPU/4 clock, or CPU/6 clock) period in ns for EMIFA or EMIFB.
|| The reference points for the rise and fall transitions are measured at VOL MAX and VOH MIN.
EH is the high period of E (EMIF input clock period) in ns and EL is the low period of E (EMIF input clock period) in ns for EMIFA or EMIFB.
This cycle-to-cycle jitter specification was measured with CPU/4 or CPU/6 as the source of the EMIF input clock.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
86 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
INPUT AND OUTPUT CLOCKS (CONTINUED)
1
5623
ECLKIN
ECLKOUT1
44
Figure 20. ECLKOUT1 Timing for EMIFA and EMIFB Modules
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for ECLKOUT2 for the EMIFA
and EMIFB modules†‡§ (see Figure 21)
NO
.
PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tJ(EKO2) Period jitter, ECLKOUT2 0±175ps
2 tw(EKO2H) Pulse duration, ECLKOUT2 high 0.5NE − 0.7 0.5NE + 0.7 ns
3 tw(EKO2L) Pulse duration, ECLKOUT2 low 0.5NE − 0.7 0.5NE + 0.7 ns
4 tt(EKO2) Transition time, ECLKOUT2 1 ns
5 td(EKIH-EKO2H) Delay time, ECLKIN high to ECLKOUT2 high 1 8 ns
6 td(EKIH-EKO2L) Delay time, ECLKIN high to ECLKOUT2 low 1 8 ns
The reference points for the rise and fall transitions are measured at VOL MAX and VOH MIN.
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (64-bit EMIFA and 16-bit EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are
prefixed by a “B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted.
§E = the EMIF input clock (ECLKIN, CPU/4 clock, or CPU/6 clock) period in ns for EMIFA or EMIFB.
N = the EMIF input clock divider; N = 1, 2, or 4.
This cycle-to-cycle jitter specification was measured with CPU/4 or CPU/6 as the source of the EMIF input clock.
56
ECLKIN
ECLKOUT2
3
244
1
Figure 21. ECLKOUT2 Timing for the EMIFA and EMIFB Modules
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
87
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
ASYNCHRONOUS MEMORY TIMING
timing requirements for asynchronous memory cycles for EMIFA module†‡§
(see Figure 22 and Figure 23)
NO.
−5E0
−6E3
−7E3
A−5E0
A−6E3 UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
3 tsu(EDV-AREH) Setup time, EDx valid before ARE high 6.5 6.5 ns
4 th(AREH-EDV) Hold time, EDx valid after ARE high 1 1 ns
6 tsu(ARDY-EKO1H) Setup time, ARDY valid before ECLKOUTx high 3 3 ns
7 t
h(EKO1H-ARDY)
Hold time, ARDY valid after ECLKOUTx high Rev 1.1 and
earlier 1 1.5 ns
7
th(EKO1H-ARDY)
Hold time, ARDY valid after ECLKOUTx high
Rev 2.0 1.3 1.5 ns
To ensure data setup time, simply program the strobe width wide enough. ARDY is internally synchronized. The ARDY signal is only recognized
two cycles before the end of the programmed strobe time and while ARDY is low, the strobe time is extended cycle-by-cycle. When ARDY is
recognized lo w, the end of the strobe time is two cycles after ARDY is recognized high. To use ARDY as an asynchronous input, the pulse width
of the ARDY signal should be wide enough (e.g., pulse width = 2E) to ensure setup and hold time is met.
RS = Read setup, RST = Read strobe, RH = Read hold, WS = Write setup, WST = Write strobe, WH = Write hold. These parameters are
programmed via the EMIF CE space control registers.
§These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the asynchronous
memory access signals are shown as generic (AOE, ARE, and AWE) instead of AAOE, AARE, and AAWE (for EMIFA) and BAOE, BARE, and
BAWE (for EMIFB)].
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for asynchronous memory
cycles for EMIFA moduleद# (see Figure 22 and Figure 23)
NO. PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tosu(SELV-AREL) Output setup time, select signals valid to ARE low RS * E − 1.5 ns
2 toh(AREH-SELIV) Output hold time, ARE high to select signals invalid RH * E − 1.9 ns
5 td(EKO1H-AREV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to ARE valid 1 7 ns
8 tosu(SELV-AWEL) Output setup time, select signals valid to AWE low WS * E − 1.7 ns
9 toh(AWEH-SELIV) Output hold time, AWE high to select signals invalid WH * E − 1.8 ns
10 td(EKO1H-AWEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to AWE valid 1.3 7.1 ns
RS = Read setup, RST = Read strobe, RH = Read hold, WS = Write setup, WST = Write strobe, WH = Write hold. These parameters are
programmed via the EMIF CE space control registers.
§These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the asynchronous
memory access signals are shown as generic (AOE, ARE, and AWE) instead of AAOE, AARE, and AAWE (for EMIFA) and BAOE, BARE, and
BAWE (for EMIFB)].
E = ECLKOUT1 period in ns for EMIFA or EMIFB
#Select signals for EMIFA include: ACEx, ABE[7:0], AEA[22:3], AAOE; and for EMIFA writes, include AED[63:0].
Select signals EMIFB include: BCEx, BBE[1:0], BEA[20:1], BAOE; and for EMIFB writes, include BED[15:0].
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
88 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
ASYNCHRONOUS MEMORY TIMING (CONTINUED)
timing requirements for asynchronous memory cycles for EMIFB module†‡§
(see Figure 22 and Figure 23)
NO.
−5E0
−6E3
−7E3
A−5E0
A−6E3 UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
3 tsu(EDV-AREH) Setup time, EDx valid before ARE high 6.2 6.2 ns
4 th(AREH-EDV) Hold time, EDx valid after ARE high 1 1 ns
6 tsu(ARDY-EKO1H) Setup time, ARDY valid before ECLKOUTx high 3 3 ns
7 t
h(EKO1H-ARDY)
Hold time, ARDY valid after ECLKOUTx high Rev 1.1 and
earlier 1.2 1.7 ns
7
th(EKO1H-ARDY)
Hold time, ARDY valid after ECLKOUTx high
Rev 2.0 1.3 1.7 ns
To ensure data setup time, simply program the strobe width wide enough. ARDY is internally synchronized. The ARDY signal is only recognized
two cycles before the end of the programmed strobe time and while ARDY is low, the strobe time is extended cycle-by-cycle. When ARDY is
recognized lo w, the end of the strobe time is two cycles after ARDY is recognized high. To use ARDY as an asynchronous input, the pulse width
of the ARDY signal should be wide enough (e.g., pulse width = 2E) to ensure setup and hold time is met.
RS = Read setup, RST = Read strobe, RH = Read hold, WS = Write setup, WST = Write strobe, WH = Write hold. These parameters are
programmed via the EMIF CE space control registers.
§These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the asynchronous
memory access signals are shown as generic (AOE, ARE, and AWE) instead of AAOE, AARE, and AAWE (for EMIFA) and BAOE, BARE, and
BAWE (for EMIFB)].
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for asynchronous memory
cycles for EMIFB moduleद# (see Figure 22 and Figure 23)
NO. PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tosu(SELV-AREL) Output setup time, select signals valid to ARE low RS * E − 1.6 ns
2 toh(AREH-SELIV) Output hold time, ARE high to select signals invalid RH * E − 1.7 ns
5 td(EKO1H-AREV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to ARE valid 0.8 6.6 ns
8 tosu(SELV-AWEL) Output setup time, select signals valid to AWE low WS * E − 1.9 ns
9 toh(AWEH-SELIV) Output hold time, AWE high to select signals invalid WH * E − 1.7 ns
10 td(EKO1H-AWEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to AWE valid 0.9 6.7 ns
RS = Read setup, RST = Read strobe, RH = Read hold, WS = Write setup, WST = Write strobe, WH = Write hold. These parameters are
programmed via the EMIF CE space control registers.
§These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the asynchronous
memory access signals are shown as generic (AOE, ARE, and AWE) instead of AAOE, AARE, and AAWE (for EMIFA) and BAOE, BARE, and
BAWE (for EMIFB)].
E = ECLKOUT1 period in ns for EMIFA or EMIFB
#Select signals for EMIFA include: ACEx, ABE[7:0], AEA[22:3], AAOE; and for EMIFA writes, include AED[63:0].
Select signals EMIFB include: BCEx, BBE[1:0], BEA[20:1], BAOE; and for EMIFB writes, include BED[15:0].
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
89
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
ASYNCHRONOUS MEMORY TIMING (CONTINUED)
77
66
Setup = 2 Strobe = 3 Not Ready Hold = 2
BE
Address
1
1
1
1
5
4
5
2
2
2
2
3
Read Data
ARDY
ECLKOUTx
CEx
AEA[22:3] or BEA[20:1]
AED[63:0] or BED[15:0]
AOE/SDRAS/SOE
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE
ABE[7:0] or BBE[1:0]
AWE/SDWE/SWE
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the asynchronous
memory access signals are shown as generic (AOE, ARE, and AWE) instead of AAOE, AARE, and AAWE (for EMIFA) and BAOE, BARE, and
BAWE (for EMIFB)].
AOE/SDRAS/SOE, ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE, and AWE/SDWE/SWE operate as AOE (identified under select signals), ARE, and AWE,
respectively, during asynchronous memory accesses.
Figure 22. Asynchronous Memory Read Timing for EMIFA and EMIFB
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
90 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
ASYNCHRONOUS MEMORY TIMING (CONTINUED)
Setup = 2 Strobe = 3 Not Ready Hold = 2
BE
Address
Write Data
10
10
8
8
8
8
77 6
6
9
9
9
9
ECLKOUTx
CEx
AEA[22:3] or BEA[20:1]
AED[63:0] or BED[15:0]
ABE[7:0] or BBE[1:0]
ARDY
AOE/SDRAS/SOE
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE
AWE/SDWE/SWE
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the asynchronous
memory access signals are shown as generic (AOE, ARE, and AWE) instead of AAOE, AARE, and AAWE (for EMIFA) and BAOE, BARE, and
BAWE (for EMIFB)].
AOE/SDRAS/SOE, ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE, and AWE/SDWE/SWE operate as AOE (identified under select signals), ARE, and AWE,
respectively, during asynchronous memory accesses.
Figure 23. Asynchronous Memory Write Timing for EMIFA and EMIFB
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
91
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
PROGRAMMABLE SYNCHRONOUS INTERFACE TIMING
timing requirements for programmable synchronous interface cycles for EMIFA module
(see Figure 24)
NO. −5E0
A−5E0
−6E3
A−6E3
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
6 tsu(EDV-EKOxH) Setup time, read EDx valid before ECLKOUTx high 3.1 2 ns
7 th(EKOxH-EDV) Hold time, read EDx valid after ECLKOUTx high 1.5 1.5 ns
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the programmable
synchronous interface access signals are shown as generic (SADS/SRE, SOE, and SWE) instead of ASADS/ASRE, ASOE, and ASWE (for
EMIFA) and BSADS/BSRE, BSOE, and BSWE (for EMIFB)].
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for programmable
synchronous interface cycles for EMIFA module†‡ (see Figure 24−Figure 26)
NO. PARAMETER −5E0
A−5E0
−6E3
A−6E3
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
1 td(EKOxH-CEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to CEx valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 4.9 ns
2 td(EKOxH-BEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to BEx valid 6.4 4.9 ns
3 td(EKOxH-BEIV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to BEx invalid 1.3 1.3 ns
4 td(EKOxH-EAV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EAx valid 6.4 4.9 ns
5 td(EKOxH-EAIV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EAx invalid 1.3 1.3 ns
8 td(EKOxH-ADSV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to SADS/SRE valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 4.9 ns
9 td(EKOxH-OEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to, SOE valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 4.9 ns
10 td(EKOxH-EDV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EDx valid 6.4 4.9 ns
11 td(EKOxH-EDIV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EDx invalid 1.3 1.3 ns
12 td(EKOxH-WEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to SWE valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 4.9 ns
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the programmable
synchronous interface access signals are shown as generic (SADS/SRE, SOE, and SWE) instead of ASADS/ASRE, ASOE, and ASWE (for
EMIFA) and BSADS/BSRE, BSOE, and BSWE (for EMIFB)].
The following parameters are programmable via the EMIF CE Space Secondary Control register (CExSEC):
Read latency (SYNCRL): 0-, 1-, 2-, or 3-cycle read latency
Write latency (SYNCWL): 0-, 1-, 2-, or 3-cycle write latency
CEx assertion length (CEEXT): For standard SBSRAM or ZBT SRAM interface, CEx goes inactive after the final command has been issued
(CEEXT = 0). For synchronous FIFO interface with glue, CEx is active when SOE is active (CEEXT = 1).
Function of SADS/SRE (RENEN): For standard SBSRAM or ZBT SRAM interface, SADS/SRE acts as SADS with deselect cycles
(RENEN = 0). For FIFO interface, SADS/SRE acts as SRE with NO deselect cycles (RENEN = 1).
Synchronization clock (SNCCLK): Synchronized to ECLKOUT1 or ECLKOUT2
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
92 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
PROGRAMMABLE SYNCHRONOUS INTERFACE TIMING (CONTINUED)
timing requirements for programmable synchronous interface cycles for EMIFB module
(see Figure 24)
NO. −5E0
A−5E0
−6E3
A−6E3
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
6 tsu(EDV-EKOxH) Setup time, read EDx valid before ECLKOUTx high 3.1 3.1 ns
7 th(EKOxH-EDV) Hold time, read EDx valid after ECLKOUTx high 1.5 1.5 ns
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the programmable
synchronous interface access signals are shown as generic (SADS/SRE, SOE, and SWE) instead of ASADS/ASRE, ASOE, and ASWE (for
EMIFA) and BSADS/BSRE, BSOE, and BSWE (for EMIFB)].
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for programmable
synchronous interface cycles for EMIFB module†‡ (see Figure 24−Figure 26)
NO. PARAMETER −5E0
A−5E0
−6E3
A−6E3
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
1 td(EKOxH-CEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to CEx valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 6.4 ns
2 td(EKOxH-BEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to BEx valid 6.4 6.4 ns
3 td(EKOxH-BEIV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to BEx invalid 1.3 1.3 ns
4 td(EKOxH-EAV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EAx valid 6.4 6.4 ns
5 td(EKOxH-EAIV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EAx invalid 1.3 1.3 ns
8 td(EKOxH-ADSV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to SADS/SRE valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 6.4 ns
9 td(EKOxH-OEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to, SOE valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 6.4 ns
10 td(EKOxH-EDV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EDx valid 6.4 6.4 ns
11 td(EKOxH-EDIV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EDx invalid 1.3 1.3 ns
12 td(EKOxH-WEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to SWE valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 6.4 ns
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the programmable
synchronous interface access signals are shown as generic (SADS/SRE, SOE, and SWE) instead of ASADS/ASRE, ASOE, and ASWE (for
EMIFA) and BSADS/BSRE, BSOE, and BSWE (for EMIFB)].
The following parameters are programmable via the EMIF CE Space Secondary Control register (CExSEC):
Read latency (SYNCRL): 0-, 1-, 2-, or 3-cycle read latency
Write latency (SYNCWL): 0-, 1-, 2-, or 3-cycle write latency
CEx assertion length (CEEXT): For standard SBSRAM or ZBT SRAM interface, CEx goes inactive after the final command has been issued
(CEEXT = 0). For synchronous FIFO interface with glue, CEx is active when SOE is active (CEEXT = 1).
Function of SADS/SRE (RENEN): For standard SBSRAM or ZBT SRAM interface, SADS/SRE acts as SADS with deselect cycles
(RENEN = 0). For FIFO interface, SADS/SRE acts as SRE with NO deselect cycles (RENEN = 1).
Synchronization clock (SNCCLK): Synchronized to ECLKOUT1 or ECLKOUT2
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
93
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
PROGRAMMABLE SYNCHRONOUS INTERFACE TIMING (CONTINUED)
ECLKOUTx
CEx
ABE[7:0] or BBE[1:0]
AEA[22:3] or BEA[20:1]
AED[63:0] or BED[15:0]
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE§
AOE/SDRAS/SOE§
AWE/SDWE/SWE§
BE1 BE2 BE3 BE4
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
9
1
45
8
9
67
3
1
2BE1 BE2 BE3 BE4
EA1 EA2 EA4
8
READ latency = 2
EA3
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the programmable
synchronous interface access signals are shown as generic (SADS/SRE, SOE, and SWE) instead of ASADS/ASRE, ASOE, and ASWE (for
EMIFA) and BSADS/BSRE, BSOE, and BSWE (for EMIFB)].
The read latency and the length of CEx assertion are programmable via the SYNCRL and CEEXT fields, respectively, in the EMIFx CE Space
Secondary Control register (CExSEC). In this figure, SYNCRL = 2 and CEEXT = 0.
§The following parameters are programmable via the EMIF CE Space Secondary Control register (CExSEC):
Read latency (SYNCRL): 0-, 1-, 2-, or 3-cycle read latency
Write latency (SYNCWL): 0-, 1-, 2-, or 3-cycle write latency
CEx assertion length (CEEXT): For standard SBSRAM or ZBT SRAM interface, CEx goes inactive after the final command has been issued
(CEEXT = 0). For synchronous FIFO interface with glue, CEx is active when SOE is active (CEEXT = 1).
Function of SADS/SRE (RENEN): For standard SBSRAM or ZBT SRAM interface, SADS/SRE acts as SADS with deselect cycles
(RENEN = 0). For FIFO interface, SADS/SRE acts as SRE with NO deselect cycles (RENEN = 1).
Synchronization clock (SNCCLK): Synchronized to ECLKOUT1 or ECLKOUT2
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE, AOE/SDRAS/SOE, and AWE/SDWE/SWE operate as SADS/SRE, SOE, and SWE, respectively, during
programmable synchronous interface accesses.
Figure 24. Programmable Synchronous Interface Read Timing for EMIFA and EMIFB
(With Read Latency = 2)†‡§
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
94 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
PROGRAMMABLE SYNCHRONOUS INTERFACE TIMING (CONTINUED)
ECLKOUTx
CEx
ABE[7:0] or BBE[1:0]
AEA[22:3] or BEA[20:1]
AED[63:0] or BED[15:0]
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE
AOE/SDRAS/SOE
AWE/SDWE/SWE
BE1 BE2 BE3 BE4
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
12
11
3
1
12
10
4
2
1
8
5
8
EA1 EA2 EA3 EA4
10
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the programmable
synchronous interface access signals are shown as generic (SADS/SRE, SOE, and SWE) instead of ASADS/ASRE, ASOE, and ASWE (for
EMIFA) and BSADS/BSRE, BSOE, and BSWE (for EMIFB)].
The write latency and the length of CEx assertion are programmable via the SYNCWL and CEEXT fields, respectively, in the EMIFx CE Space
Secondary Control register (CExSEC). In this figure, SYNCWL = 0 and CEEXT = 0.
§The following parameters are programmable via the EMIF CE Space Secondary Control register (CExSEC):
Read latency (SYNCRL): 0-, 1-, 2-, or 3-cycle read latency
Write latency (SYNCWL): 0-, 1-, 2-, or 3-cycle write latency
CEx assertion length (CEEXT): For standard SBSRAM or ZBT SRAM interface, CEx goes inactive after the final command has been issued
(CEEXT = 0). For synchronous FIFO interface with glue, CEx is active when SOE is active (CEEXT = 1).
Function of SADS/SRE (RENEN): For standard SBSRAM or ZBT SRAM interface, SADS/SRE acts as SADS with deselect cycles
(RENEN = 0). For FIFO interface, SADS/SRE acts as SRE with NO deselect cycles (RENEN = 1).
Synchronization clock (SNCCLK): Synchronized to ECLKOUT1 or ECLKOUT2
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE, AOE/SDRAS/SOE, and AWE/SDWE/SWE operate as SADS/SRE, SOE, and SWE, respectively, during
programmable synchronous interface accesses.
Figure 25. Programmable Synchronous Interface Write Timing for EMIFA and EMIFB
(With Write Latency = 0)†‡§
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
95
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
PROGRAMMABLE SYNCHRONOUS INTERFACE TIMING (CONTINUED)
ECLKOUTx
CEx
ABE[7:0] or BBE[1:0]
AEA[22:3] or BEA[20:1]
AED[63:0] or BED[15:0]
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE
AOE/SDRAS/SOE
AWE/SDWE/SWE
BE1 BE2 BE3 BE4
Q1 Q2 Q3 11
3
12
10
4
2
1
8
5
8
EA1 EA2 EA3 EA4
10
Write
Latency =
1
1
Q4
12
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the programmable
synchronous interface access signals are shown as generic (SADS/SRE, SOE, and SWE) instead of ASADS/ASRE, ASOE, and ASWE (for
EMIFA) and BSADS/BSRE, BSOE, and BSWE (for EMIFB)].
The write latency and the length of CEx assertion are programmable via the SYNCWL and CEEXT fields, respectively, in the EMIFx CE Space
Secondary Control register (CExSEC). In this figure, SYNCWL = 1 and CEEXT = 0.
§The following parameters are programmable via the EMIF CE Space Secondary Control register (CExSEC):
Read latency (SYNCRL): 0-, 1-, 2-, or 3-cycle read latency
Write latency (SYNCWL): 0-, 1-, 2-, or 3-cycle write latency
CEx assertion length (CEEXT): For standard SBSRAM or ZBT SRAM interface, CEx goes inactive after the final command has been issued
(CEEXT = 0). For synchronous FIFO interface with glue, CEx is active when SOE is active (CEEXT = 1).
Function of SADS/SRE (RENEN): For standard SBSRAM or ZBT SRAM interface, SADS/SRE acts as SADS with deselect cycles
(RENEN = 0). For FIFO interface, SADS/SRE acts as SRE with NO deselect cycles (RENEN = 1).
Synchronization clock (SNCCLK): Synchronized to ECLKOUT1 or ECLKOUT2
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE, AOE/SDRAS/SOE, and AWE/SDWE/SWE operate as SADS/SRE, SOE, and SWE, respectively, during
programmable synchronous interface accesses.
Figure 26. Programmable Synchronous Interface Write Timing for EMIFA and EMIFB
(With Write Latency = 1)†‡§
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
96 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
SYNCHRONOUS DRAM TIMING
timing requirements for synchronous DRAM cycles for EMIFA module (see Figure 27)
NO. −5E0
A−5E0
−6E3
A−6E3
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
6 tsu(EDV-EKO1H) Setup time, read EDx valid before ECLKOUTx high 2.1 0.6 ns
7 th(EKO1H-EDV) Hold time, read EDx valid after ECLKOUTx high 2.5 1.8 ns
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the synchronous DRAM
memory access signals are shown as generic ( SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS ) instead of ASDCAS, ASDWE, and ASDRAS (for EMIFA) and
BSDCAS, BSDWE, and BSDRAS (for EMIFB)].
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for synchronous DRAM cycles
for EMIFA module (see Figure 27−Figure 34)
NO. PARAMETER −5E0
A−5E0
−6E3
A−6E3
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
1 td(EKO1H-CEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to CEx valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 4.9 ns
2 td(EKO1H-BEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to BEx valid 6.4 4.9 ns
3 td(EKO1H-BEIV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to BEx invalid 1.3 1.3 ns
4 td(EKO1H-EAV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EAx valid 6.4 4.9 ns
5 td(EKO1H-EAIV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EAx invalid 1.3 1.3 ns
8 td(EKO1H-CASV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to SDCAS valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 4.9 ns
9 td(EKO1H-EDV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EDx valid 6.4 4.9 ns
10 td(EKO1H-EDIV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EDx invalid 1.3 1.3 ns
11 td(EKO1H-WEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to SDWE valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 4.9 ns
12 td(EKO1H-RAS) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to SDRAS valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 4.9 ns
13 td(EKO1H-ACKEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to ASDCKE valid (EMIFA only) 1.3 6.4 1.3 4.9 ns
14 td(EKO1H-PDTV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to PDT valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 4.9 ns
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the synchronous DRAM
memory access signals are shown as generic ( SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS ) instead of ASDCAS, ASDWE, and ASDRAS (for EMIFA) and
BSDCAS, BSDWE, and BSDRAS (for EMIFB)].
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
97
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
SYNCHRONOUS DRAM TIMING (CONTINUED)
timing requirements for synchronous DRAM cycles for EMIFB module (see Figure 27)
NO. −5E0
A−5E0
−6E3
A−6E3
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
6 tsu(EDV-EKO1H) Setup time, read EDx valid before ECLKOUTx high 2.1 2.1 ns
7 th(EKO1H-EDV) Hold time, read EDx valid after ECLKOUTx high 2.5 2.5 ns
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the synchronous DRAM
memory access signals are shown as generic ( SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS ) instead of ASDCAS, ASDWE, and ASDRAS (for EMIFA) and
BSDCAS, BSDWE, and BSDRAS (for EMIFB)].
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for synchronous DRAM cycles
for EMIFB module (see Figure 27−Figure 34)
NO. PARAMETER −5E0
A−5E0
−6E3
A−6E3
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
1 td(EKO1H-CEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to CEx valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 6.4 ns
2 td(EKO1H-BEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to BEx valid 6.4 6.4 ns
3 td(EKO1H-BEIV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to BEx invalid 1.3 1.3 ns
4 td(EKO1H-EAV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EAx valid 6.4 6.4 ns
5 td(EKO1H-EAIV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EAx invalid 1.3 1.3 ns
8 td(EKO1H-CASV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to SDCAS valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 6.4 ns
9 td(EKO1H-EDV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EDx valid 6.4 6.4 ns
10 td(EKO1H-EDIV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to EDx invalid 1.3 1.3 ns
11 td(EKO1H-WEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to SDWE valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 6.4 ns
12 td(EKO1H-RAS) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to SDRAS valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 6.4 ns
13 td(EKO1H-ACKEV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to ASDCKE valid (EMIFA only) 1.3 6.4 1.3 6.4 ns
14 td(EKO1H-PDTV) Delay time, ECLKOUTx high to PDT valid 1.3 6.4 1.3 6.4 ns
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the synchronous DRAM
memory access signals are shown as generic ( SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS ) instead of ASDCAS, ASDWE, and ASDRAS (for EMIFA) and
BSDCAS, BSDWE, and BSDRAS (for EMIFB)].
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
98 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
SYNCHRONOUS DRAM TIMING (CONTINUED)
ECLKOUTx
CEx
ABE[7:0] or BBE[1:0]
AEA[12:3] or BEA[10:1]
AED[63:0] or BED[15:0]
AEA13 or BEA11
AOE/SDRAS/SOE
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE
AWE/SDWE/SWE
AEA[22:14] or BEA[20:12]
BE1 BE2 BE3 BE4
Bank
Column
D1 D2 D3 D4
8
7
6
5
5
5
1
3
2
8
4
4
4
1
READ
PDT§1414
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the synchronous DRAM
memory access signals are shown as generic ( SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS ) instead of ASDCAS, ASDWE, and ASDRAS (for EMIFA) and
BSDCAS, BSDWE, and BSDRAS (for EMIFB)].
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE, AWE/SDWE/SWE, and AOE/SDRAS/SOE operate as SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS, respectively, during SDRAM
accesses.
§PDT signal is only asserted when the EDMA is in PDT mode (set the PDTS bit to 1 in the EDMA options parameter RAM). For PDT read, data
is not latched into EMIF. The PDTRL field in the PDT control register (PDTCTL) configures the latency of the PDT signal with respect to the data
phase of a read transaction. The latency of the PDT signal for a read can be programmed to 0, 1, 2, or 3 by setting PDTRL to 00, 01, 10, or 11,
respectively. PDTRL equals 00 (zero latency) in Figure 27.
Figure 27. SDRAM Read Command (CAS Latency 3) for EMIFA and EMIFB
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
99
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
SYNCHRONOUS DRAM TIMING (CONTINUED)
ECLKOUTx
CEx
ABE[7:0] or BBE[1:0]
AEA[12:3] or BEA[10:1]
AED[63:0] or BED[15:0]
AOE/SDRAS/SOE
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE
AWE/SDWE/SWE
AEA13 or BEA11
AEA[22:14] or BEA[20:12]
BE1 BE2 BE3 BE4
Bank
Column
D1 D2 D3 D4
11
8
9
5
5
5
4
2
11
8
9
4
4
2
1
10
3
4
WRITE
PDT§1414
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the synchronous DRAM
memory access signals are shown as generic ( SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS ) instead of ASDCAS, ASDWE, and ASDRAS (for EMIFA) and
BSDCAS, BSDWE, and BSDRAS (for EMIFB)].
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE, AWE/SDWE/SWE, and AOE/SDRAS/SOE operate as SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS, respectively, during SDRAM
accesses.
§PDT signal is only asserted when the EDMA is in PDT mode (set the PDTD bit to 1 in the EDMA options parameter RAM). For PDT write, data
is not driven (in High-Z). The PDTWL field in the PDT control register (PDTCTL) configures the latency of the PDT signal with respect to the data
phase of a write transaction. The latency of the PDT signal for a write transaction can be programmed to 0, 1, 2, or 3 by setting PDTWL to 00,
01, 10, or 11, respectively. PDTWL equals 00 (zero latency) in Figure 28.
Figure 28. SDRAM Write Command for EMIFA and EMIFB
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
100 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
SYNCHRONOUS DRAM TIMING (CONTINUED)
ECLKOUTx
CEx
ABE[7:0] or BBE[1:0]
AEA[22:14] or BEA[20:12]
AED[63:0] or BED[15:0]
AEA13 or BEA11
AOE/SDRAS/SOE
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE
AWE/SDWE/SWE
Bank Activate
Row Address
Row Address
12
5
5
5
1
AEA[12:3] or BEA[10:1]
ACTV
12
4
4
4
1
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the synchronous DRAM
memory access signals are shown as generic ( SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS ) instead of ASDCAS, ASDWE, and ASDRAS (for EMIFA) and
BSDCAS, BSDWE, and BSDRAS (for EMIFB)].
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE, AWE/SDWE/SWE, and AOE/SDRAS/SOE operate as SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS, respectively, during SDRAM
accesses.
Figure 29. SDRAM ACTV Command for EMIFA and EMFB
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
101
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
SYNCHRONOUS DRAM TIMING (CONTINUED)
ECLKOUTx
CEx
ABE[7:0] or BBE[1:0]
AEA[22:14, 12:3] or
BEA[20:12, 10:1]
AED[63:0] or BED[15:0]
AEA13 or BEA11
AOE/SDRAS/SOE
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE
AWE/SDWE/SWE11
12
5
1
DCAB
11
12
4
1
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the synchronous DRAM
memory access signals are shown as generic ( SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS ) instead of ASDCAS, ASDWE, and ASDRAS (for EMIFA) and
BSDCAS, BSDWE, and BSDRAS (for EMIFB)].
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE, AWE/SDWE/SWE, and AOE/SDRAS/SOE operate as SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS, respectively, during SDRAM
accesses.
Figure 30. SDRAM DCAB Command for EMIFA and EMIFB
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
102 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
SYNCHRONOUS DRAM TIMING (CONTINUED)
ECLKOUTx
CEx
ABE[7:0] or BBE[1:0]
AEA[22:14] or BEA[20:12]
AED[63:0] or BED[15:0]
AEA13 or BEA11
AOE/SDRAS/SOE
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE
AWE/SDWE/SWE
AEA[12:3] or BEA[10:1]
Bank
11
12
5
5
1
DEAC
11
12
4
4
1
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the synchronous DRAM
memory access signals are shown as generic ( SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS ) instead of ASDCAS, ASDWE, and ASDRAS (for EMIFA) and
BSDCAS, BSDWE, and BSDRAS (for EMIFB)].
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE, AWE/SDWE/SWE, and AOE/SDRAS/SOE operate as SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS, respectively, during SDRAM
accesses.
Figure 31. SDRAM DEAC Command for EMIFA and EMIFB
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
103
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
SYNCHRONOUS DRAM TIMING (CONTINUED)
ECLKOUTx
CEx
ABE[7:0] or BBE[1:0]
AEA[22:14, 12:3] or
BEA[20:12, 10:1]
AED[63:0] or BED[15:0]
AEA13 or BEA11
AOE/SDRAS/SOE
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE
AWE/SDWE/SWE
8
12
1
REFR
8
12
1
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the synchronous DRAM
memory access signals are shown as generic ( SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS ) instead of ASDCAS, ASDWE, and ASDRAS (for EMIFA) and
BSDCAS, BSDWE, and BSDRAS (for EMIFB)].
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE, AWE/SDWE/SWE, and AOE/SDRAS/SOE operate as SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS, respectively, during SDRAM
accesses.
Figure 32. SDRAM REFR Command for EMIFA and EMIFB
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
104 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
SYNCHRONOUS DRAM TIMING (CONTINUED)
ECLKOUTx
CEx
ABE[7:0] or BBE[1:0]
AEA[22:3] or BEA[20:1]
AED[63:0] or BED[15:0]
AOE/SDRAS/SOE
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE
AWE/SDWE/SWE
MRS value
11
8
12
5
1
MRS
11
8
12
4
1
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the synchronous DRAM
memory access signals are shown as generic ( SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS ) instead of ASDCAS, ASDWE, and ASDRAS (for EMIFA) and
BSDCAS, BSDWE, and BSDRAS (for EMIFB)].
ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE, AWE/SDWE/SWE, and AOE/SDRAS/SOE operate as SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS, respectively, during SDRAM
accesses.
Figure 33. SDRAM MRS Command for EMIFA and EMIFB
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
105
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
SYNCHRONOUS DRAM TIMING (CONTINUED)
End Self-Refresh
Self Refresh
13
13
AECLKOUTx
ACEx
ABE[7:0]
AEA[22:14, 12:3]
AEA13
AED[63:0]
AAOE/ASDRAS/ASOE
AARE/ASDCAS/ASADS/
ASRE
AAWE/ASDWE/ASWE
ASDCKE
TRAS cycles
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., the synchronous DRAM
memory access signals are shown as generic ( SDCAS, SDWE, and SDRAS ) instead of ASDCAS, ASDWE, and ASDRAS (for EMIFA) and
BSDCAS, BSDWE, and BSDRAS (for EMIFB)].
AARE/ASDCAS/ASADS/ASRE, AAWE/ASDWE/ASWE, and AAOE/ASDRAS/ASOE operate as ASDCAS, ASDWE, and ASDRAS,
respectively, during SDRAM accesses.
Figure 34. SDRAM Self-Refresh Timing for EMIFA Only
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
106 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
HOLD/HOLDA TIMING
timing requirements for the HOLD/HOLDA cycles for EMIFA and EMIFB modules (see Figure 35)
NO. −5E0
A−5E0
−6E3
A−6E3
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
3 th(HOLDAL-HOLDL) Hold time, HOLD low after HOLDA low E E ns
E = the EMIF input clock (ECLKIN, CPU/4 clock, or CPU/6 clock) period in ns for EMIFA or EMIFB.
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for the HOLD/HOLDA cycles
for EMIFA and EMIFB modules†‡§ (see Figure 35)
NO. PARAMETER −5E0
A−5E0
−6E3
A−6E3
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
1 td(HOLDL-EMHZ) Delay time, HOLD low to EMIF Bus high impedance 2E 2E ns
2 td(EMHZ-HOLDAL) Delay time, EMIF Bus high impedance to HOLDA low 0 2E 0 2E ns
4 td(HOLDH-EMLZ) Delay time, HOLD high to EMIF Bus low impedance 2E 7E 2E 7E ns
5 td(EMLZ-HOLDAH) Delay time, EMIF Bus low impedance to HOLDA high 0 2E 0 2E ns
6 td(HOLDL-EKOHZ) Delay time, HOLD low to ECLKOUTx high impedance 2E 2E ns
7 td(HOLDH-EKOLZ) Delay time, HOLD high to ECLKOUTx low impedance 2E 7E 2E 7E ns
E = the EMIF input clock (ECLKIN, CPU/4 clock, or CPU/6 clock) period in ns for EMIFA or EMIFB.
For EMIFA, EMIF Bus consists of: ACE[3:0], ABE[7:0], AED[63:0], AEA[22:3], AARE/ASDCAS/ASADS/ASRE, AAOE/ASDRAS/ASOE, and
AAWE/ASDWE/ASWE , ASDCKE, ASOE3, and APDT.
For EMIFB, EMIF Bus consists of: BCE[3:0], BBE[1:0], BED[15:0], BEA[20:1], BARE/BSDCAS/BSADS/BSRE, BAOE/BSDRAS/BSOE, and
BAWE/BSDWE/BSWE, BSOE3, and BPDT.
§The EKxHZ bits in the EMIF Global Control register (GBLCTL) determine the state of the ECLKOUTx signals during HOLDA. If EKxHZ = 0,
ECLKOUTx continues clocking during Hold mode. If EKxHZ = 1, ECLKOUTx goes to high impedance during Hold mode, as shown in Figure 35.
All pending EMIF transactions are allowed to complete before HOLDA is asserted. If no bus transactions are occurring, then the minimum delay
time can be achieved. Also, bus hold can be indefinitely delayed by setting NOHOLD = 1.
HOLD
HOLDA
EMIF Bus
DSP Owns Bus External Requestor
Owns Bus DSP Owns Bus
C64x C64x
1
3
25
4
ECLKOUTx
(EKxHZ = 0)
ECLKOUTx
(EKxHZ = 1)
67
For EMIFA, EMIF Bus consists of: ACE[3:0], ABE[7:0], AED[63:0], AEA[22:3], AARE/ASDCAS/ASADS/ASRE, AAOE/ASDRAS/ASOE, and
AAWE/ASDWE/ASWE, ASDCKE, ASOE3, and APDT.
For EMIFB, EMIF Bus consists of: BCE[3:0], BBE[1:0], BED[15:0], BEA[20:1], BARE/BSDCAS/BSADS/BSRE, BAOE/BSDRAS/BSOE, and
BAWE/BSDWE/BSWE, BSOE3, and BPDT.
The EKxHZ bits in the EMIF Global Control register (GBLCTL) determine the state of the ECLKOUTx signals during HOLDA. If EKxHZ = 0,
ECLKOUTx continues clocking during Hold mode. If EKxHZ = 1, ECLKOUTx goes to high impedance during Hold mode, as shown in Figure 35.
Figure 35. HOLD/HOLDA Timing for EMIFA and EMIFB
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
107
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
BUSREQ TIMING
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for the BUSREQ cycles
for EMIFA and EMIFB modules (see Figure 36)
NO. PARAMETER −5E0
A−5E0
−6E3
A−6E3
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
1 td(AEKO1H-ABUSRV) Delay time, AECLKOUTx high to ABUSREQ valid 0.6 7.1 1 5.5 ns
2 td(BEKO1H-BBUSRV) Delay time, BECLKOUTx high to BBUSREQ valid 0.5 6.9 0.9 5.5 ns
ECLKOUTx
1
ABUSREQ
1
22
BBUSREQ
Figure 36. BUSREQ Timing for EMIFA and EMIFB
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
108 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
RESET TIMING
timing requirements for reset (see Figure 37)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3, −7E3
UNIT
NO.
MIN MAX
UNIT
1
tw(RST)
Width of the RESET pulse (PLL stable)10P ns
1 tw(RST) Width of the RESET pulse (PLL needs to sync up)§250 µs
16 tsu(boot) Setup time, boot configuration bits valid before RESET high4E or 4C#ns
17 th(boot) Hold time, boot configuration bits valid after RESET high4P ns
18 tsu(PCLK-RSTH) Setup time, PCLK active before RESET high|| 32N ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
This parameter applies to CLKMODE x1 when CLKIN is stable, and applies to CLKMODE x6, x12 when CLKIN and PLL are stable.
§This parameter applies to CLKMODE x6, x12 only (it does not apply to CLKMODE x1). The RESET signal is not connected internally to the clock
PLL circuit. The PLL, however, may need up to 250 µs to stabilize following device power up or after PLL configuration has been changed. During
that time, RESET must be asserted to ensure proper device operation. See the clock PLL section for PLL lock times.
EMIFB address pins BEA[20:13, 11, 7] are the boot configuration pins during device reset.
#E = 1/AECLKIN clock frequency in ns. C = 1/CLKIN clock frequency in ns. Select whichever value is larger for the MIN parameter.
|| N = the PCI input clock (PCLK) period in ns. When PCI is enabled (PCI_EN = 1), this parameter must be met.
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions during resetkh (see Figure 37)
NO.
PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3, −7E3
NO.
PARAMETER
MIN MAX
2 td(RSTL-ECKI) Delay time, RESET low to ECLKIN synchronized internally 2E 3P + 20E ns
3 td(RSTH-ECKI) Delay time, RESET high to ECLKIN synchronized internally 2E 8P + 20E ns
4 td(RSTL-ECKO1HZ) Delay time, RESET low to ECLKOUT1 high impedance 2E ns
5 td(RSTH-ECKO1V) Delay time, RESET high to ECLKOUT1 valid 8P + 20E ns
6 td(RSTL-EMIFZHZ) Delay time, RESET low to EMIF Z high impedance 2E 3P + 4E ns
7 td(RSTH-EMIFZV) Delay time, RESET high to EMIF Z valid 16E 8P + 20E ns
8 td(RSTL-EMIFHIV) Delay time, RESET low to EMIF high group invalid 2E ns
9 td(RSTH-EMIFHV) Delay time, RESET high to EMIF high group valid 8P + 20E ns
10 td(RSTL-EMIFLIV) Delay time, RESET low to EMIF low group invalid 2E ns
11 td(RSTH-EMIFLV) Delay time, RESET high to EMIF low group valid 8P + 20E ns
12 td(RSTL-LOWIV) Delay time, RESET low to low group invalid 0 ns
13 td(RSTH-LOWV) Delay time, RESET high to low group valid 11P ns
14 td(RSTL-ZHZ) Delay time, RESET low to Z group high impedance 0 ns
15 td(RSTH-ZV) Delay time, RESET high to Z group valid 2P 8P ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
E = the EMIF input clock (ECLKIN, CPU/4 clock, or CPU/6 clock) period in ns for EMIFA or EMIFB.
EMIF Z group consists of: AEA[22:3], BEA[20:1], AED[63:0], BED[15:0], CE[3:0], ABE[7:0], BBE[1:0], ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE,
AWE/SDWE/SWE, and AOE/SDRAS/SOE, SOE3, ASDCKE, and PDT.
EMIF high group consists of: AHOLDA and BHOLDA (when the corresponding HOLD input is high)
EMIF low group consists of: ABUSREQ and BBUSREQ; AHOLDA and BHOLDA (when the corresponding HOLD input is low)
Low group consists of: XSP_CS, CLKX2/XSP_CLK, and DX2/XSP_DO; all of which apply only when PCI EEPROM (BEA13)
is enabled (with PCI_EN = 1 and MCBSP2_EN = 0). Otherwise, the CLKX2/XSP_CLK and DX2/XSP_DO
pins are in the Z group. For more details on the PCI configuration pins, see the Device Configurations section
of this data sheet.
Z group consists of: HD[31:0]/AD[31:0], CLKX0, CLKX1/URADDR4, CLKX2/XSP_CLK, FSX0, FSX1/UXADDR3, FSX2, DX0,
DX1/UXADDR4, DX2/XSP_DO, CLKR0, CLKR1/URADDR2, CLKR2, FSR0, FSR1/UXADDR2, FSR2,
TOUT0, TOUT1, TOUT2, GP[8:0], GP10/PCBE3, HR/W/PCBE2, HDS2/PCBE1, PCBE0, GP13/PINTA,
GP11/PREQ, HDS1/PSERR, HCS/PPERR, HCNTL1/PDEVSEL, HAS/PPAR, HCNTL0/PSTOP,
HHWIL/PTRDY (16-bit HPI mode only), HRDY/PIRDY, HINT/PFRAME, UXDATA[7:0], UXSOC, UXCLAV,
and URCLAV.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
109
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
RESET TIMING (CONTINUED)
ECLKOUT2
17
14
1
CLKOUT4
CLKOUT6
RESET
ECLKIN
Low Group
Z Group‡§
Boot and Device
Configuration Inputs§¶ 16
15
32
10
8
EMIF Z Group‡§
EMIF High Group
EMIF Low Group11
9
76
13
12
ECLKOUT1
54
PCLK
18
These C64x devices have two EMIFs (EMIFA and EMIFB). All EMIFA signals are prefixed by an “A” and all EMIFB signals are prefixed by a
“B”. Throughout the rest of this document, in generic EMIF areas of discussion, the prefix “A” or “B” may be omitted [e.g., ECLKIN, ECLKOUT1,
and ECLKOUT2].
EMIF Z group consists of: AEA[22:3], BEA[20:1], AED[63:0], BED[15:0], CE[3:0], ABE[7:0], BBE[1:0], ARE/SDCAS/SADS/SRE,
AWE/SDWE/SWE, and AOE/SDRAS/SOE, SOE3, ASDCKE, and PDT.
EMIF high group consists of: AHOLDA and BHOLDA (when the corresponding HOLD input is high)
EMIF low group consists of: ABUSREQ and BBUSREQ; AHOLDA and BHOLDA (when the corresponding HOLD input is low)
Low group consists of: XSP_CS, CLKX2/XSP_CLK, and DX2/XSP_DO; all of which apply only when PCI EEPROM (BEA13)
is enabled (with PCI_EN = 1 and MCBSP2_EN = 0). Otherwise, the CLKX2/XSP_CLK and DX2/XSP_DO
pins are in the Z group. For more details on the PCI configuration pins, see the Device Configurations section
of this data sheet.
Z group consists of: HD[31:0]/AD[31:0], CLKX0, CLKX1/URADDR4, CLKX2/XSP_CLK, FSX0, FSX1/UXADDR3, FSX2, DX0,
DX1/UXADDR4, DX2/XSP_DO, CLKR0, CLKR1/URADDR2, CLKR2, FSR0, FSR1/UXADDR2, FSR2,
TOUT0, TOUT1, TOUT2, GP[8:0], GP10/PCBE3, HR/W/PCBE2, HDS2/PCBE1, PCBE0, GP13/PINTA,
GP11/PREQ, HDS1/PSERR, HCS/PPERR, HCNTL1/PDEVSEL, HAS/PPAR, HCNTL0/PSTOP,
HHWIL/PTRDY (16-bit HPI mode only), HRDY/PIRDY, HINT/PFRAME, UXDATA[7:0], UXSOC, UXCLAV,
and URCLAV.
§If BEA[20:13, 11, 7] and HD5/AD5 pins are actively driven, care must be taken to ensure no timing contention between parameters 6, 7, 14, 15,
16, and 17.
Boot and Device Configurations Inputs (during reset) include: EMIFB address pins BEA[20:13, 11, 7] and HD5/AD5.
The PCI_EN pin must be driven valid at all times and the user must not switch values throughout device operation.
The MCBSP2_EN pin must be driven valid at all times and the user can switch values throughout device operation.
Figure 37. Reset Timing
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
110 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
EXTERNAL INTERRUPT TIMING
timing requirements for external interrupts (see Figure 38)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1
tw(ILOW)
Width of the NMI interrupt pulse low 4P ns
1 tw(ILOW) Width of the EXT_INT interrupt pulse low 8P ns
2
tw(IHIGH)
Width of the NMI interrupt pulse high 4P ns
2
t
w(IHIGH) Width of the EXT_INT interrupt pulse high 8P ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
2
1
EXT_INTx, NMI
Figure 38. External/NMI Interrupt Timing
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
111
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
HOST-PORT INTERFACE (HPI) TIMING
timing requirements for host-port interface cycles†‡ (see Figure 39 through Figure 46)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tsu(SELV-HSTBL) Setup time, select signals§ valid before HSTROBE low 5 ns
2 th(HSTBL-SELV) Hold time, select signals§ valid after HSTROBE low 2.4 ns
3 tw(HSTBL) Pulse duration, HSTROBE low 4Pns
4 tw(HSTBH) Pulse duration, HSTROBE high between consecutive accesses 4P ns
10 tsu(SELV-HASL) Setup time, select signals§ valid before HAS low 5 ns
11 th(HASL-SELV) Hold time, select signals§ valid after HAS low 2 ns
12 tsu(HDV-HSTBH) Setup time, host data valid before HSTROBE high 5 ns
13 th(HSTBH-HDV) Hold time, host data valid after HSTROBE high 2.8 ns
14 th(HRDYL-HSTBL)
Hold time, HSTROBE low after HRDY low. HSTROBE should not be
inactivated until HRDY is active (low); otherwise, HPI writes will not complete
properly. 2 ns
18 tsu(HASL-HSTBL) Setup time, HAS low before HSTROBE low 2 ns
19 th(HSTBL-HASL) Hold time, HAS low after HSTROBE low 2.1 ns
HSTROBE refers to the following logical operation on HCS, HDS1, and HDS2: [NOT(HDS1 XOR HDS2)] OR HCS.
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
§Select signals include: HCNTL[1:0] and HR/W. For HPI16 mode only, select signals also include HHWIL.
Select the parameter value of 4P or 12.5 ns, whichever is greater.
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions during host-port interface
cycles†‡ (see Figure 39 through Figure 46)
NO. PARAMETER
−5E0
−6E3
−7E3
A−5E0
A−6E3 UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
6 td(HSTBL-HRDYH) Delay time, HSTROBE low to HRDY high#1.3 4P + 8 1.3 4P + 9 ns
7 td(HSTBL-HDLZ) Delay time, HSTROBE low to HD low impedance for an
HPI read 2 2 ns
8 td(HDV-HRDYL) Delay time, HD valid to HRDY low −3 −3 ns
9 toh(HSTBH-HDV) Output hold time, HD valid after HSTROBE high 1.5 1.5 ns
15 td(HSTBH-HDHZ) Delay time, HSTROBE high to HD high impedance 12 12 ns
16 td(HSTBL-HDV) Delay time, HSTROBE low to HD valid
(HPI16 mode, 2nd half-word only) 4P + 8 4P + 8 ns
HSTROBE refers to the following logical operation on HCS, HDS1, and HDS2: [NOT(HDS1 XOR HDS2)] OR HCS.
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
#This parameter is used during HPID reads and writes. For reads, at the beginning of a word transfer (HPI32) or the first half-word transfer (HPI16)
on the falling edge of HSTROBE, the HPI sends the request to the EDMA internal address generation hardware, and HRDY remains high until
the EDMA internal address generation hardware loads the requested data into HPID. For writes, HRDY goes high if the internal write buffer is
full.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
112 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
HOST-PORT INTERFACE (HPI) TIMING (CONTINUED)
1st half-word 2nd half-word
86
15
916
15
97
4
3
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
HAS
HCNTL[1:0]
HR/W
HHWIL
HSTROBE
HCS
HD[15:0] (output)
HRDY
3
HSTROBE refers to the following logical operation on HCS, HDS1, and HDS2: [NOT(HDS1 XOR HDS2)] OR HCS.
Figure 39. HPI16 Read Timing (HAS Not Used, Tied High)
HAS
HCNTL[1:0]
HR/W
HHWIL
HSTROBE
HCS
HD[15:0] (output)
HRDY
1st half-word 2nd half-word
86
15
916
15
97
4
3
11
10
11
10
11
10
11
10
11
1011
10 19 19
18
18
For correct operation, strobe the HAS signal only once per HSTROBE active cycle.
HSTROBE refers to the following logical operation on HCS, HDS1, and HDS2: [NOT(HDS1 XOR HDS2)] OR HCS.
Figure 40. HPI16 Read Timing (HAS Used)
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
113
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
HOST-PORT INTERFACE (HPI) TIMING (CONTINUED)
1st half-word 2nd half-word
13
12
13
12
4
14
3
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
HAS
HCNTL[1:0]
HR/W
HHWIL
HSTROBE
HCS
HD[15:0] (input)
HRDY
3
6
HSTROBE refers to the following logical operation on HCS, HDS1, and HDS2: [NOT(HDS1 XOR HDS2)] OR HCS.
Figure 41. HPI16 Write Timing (HAS Not Used, Tied High)
1st half-word 2nd half-word
13
12
13
12
4
14
3
11
10
11
10
11
10
11
10
11
10
11
10
HAS
HCNTL[1:0]
HR/W
HHWIL
HSTROBE
HCS
HD[15:0] (input)
HRDY
1919
18 18
6
For correct operation, strobe the HAS signal only once per HSTROBE active cycle.
HSTROBE refers to the following logical operation on HCS, HDS1, and HDS2: [NOT(HDS1 XOR HDS2)] OR HCS.
Figure 42. HPI16 Write Timing (HAS Used)
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
114 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
HOST-PORT INTERFACE (HPI) TIMING (CONTINUED)
6
3
HAS
HCNTL[1:0]
HR/W
HSTROBE
HCS
HD[31:0] (output)
HRDY 8
9
7
21
21
15
HSTROBE refers to the following logical operation on HCS, HDS1, and HDS2: [NOT(HDS1 XOR HDS2)] OR HCS.
Figure 43. HPI32 Read Timing (HAS Not Used, Tied High)
86
15
97
3
18
11
10
11
10
19
HAS
HCNTL[1:0]
HR/W
HSTROBE
HCS
HD[31:0] (output)
HRDY
For correct operation, strobe the HAS signal only once per HSTROBE active cycle.
HSTROBE refers to the following logical operation on HCS, HDS1, and HDS2: [NOT(HDS1 XOR HDS2)] OR HCS.
Figure 44. HPI32 Read Timing (HAS Used)
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
115
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
HOST-PORT INTERFACE (HPI) TIMING (CONTINUED)
1312
14
3
21
21
HAS
HCNTL[1:0]
HR/W
HSTROBE
HCS
HD[31:0] (input)
HRDY 6
HSTROBE refers to the following logical operation on HCS, HDS1, and HDS2: [NOT(HDS1 XOR HDS2)] OR HCS.
Figure 45. HPI32 Write Timing (HAS Not Used, Tied High)
1312
14
3
18
11
10
11
10
19
HAS
HCNTL[1:0]
HR/W
HSTROBE
HCS
HD[31:0] (input)
HRDY 6
For correct operation, strobe the HAS signal only once per HSTROBE active cycle.
HSTROBE refers to the following logical operation on HCS, HDS1, and HDS2: [NOT(HDS1 XOR HDS2)] OR HCS.
Figure 46. HPI32 Write Timing (HAS Used)
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
116 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
PERIPHERAL COMPONENT INTERCONNECT (PCI) TIMING [C6415 AND C6416 ONLY]
timing requirements for PCLK†‡ (see Figure 47)
NO
.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tc(PCLK) Cycle time, PCLK 30 (or 8P§) ns
2 tw(PCLKH) Pulse duration, PCLK high 11 ns
3 tw(PCLKL) Pulse duration, PCLK low 11 ns
4 tsr(PCLK) v/t slew rate, PCLK 1 4 V/ns
For 3.3-V operation, the reference points for the rise and fall transitions are measured at VILP MAX and VIHP MIN.
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
§Select the parameter value of 30 ns or 8P, whichever is greater.
PCLK
1
2
3
4
4
0.4 DVDD V MIN
Peak to Peak for
3.3V signaling
Figure 47. PCLK Timing
timing requirements for PCI reset (see Figure 48)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tw(PRST) Pulse duration, PRST 1 ms
2 tsu(PCLKA-PRSTH) Setup time, PCLK active before PRST high 100 µs
PRST
PCLK
2
1
Figure 48. PCI Reset (PRST) Timing
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
117
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
PERIPHERAL COMPONENT INTERCONNECT (PCI) TIMING [C6415 AND C6416 ONLY]
(CONTINUED)
timing requirements for PCI inputs (see Figure 49)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
5 tsu(IV-PCLKH) Setup time, input valid before PCLK high 7 ns
6 th(IV-PCLKH) Hold time, input valid after PCLK high 0 ns
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for PCI outputs (see Figure 49)
NO. PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 td(PCLKH-OV) Delay time, PCLK high to output valid 11 ns
2 td(PCLKH-OIV) Delay time, PCLK high to output invalid 2 ns
3 td(PCLKH-OLZ) Delay time, PCLK high to output low impedance 2 ns
4 td(PCLKH-OHZ) Delay time, PCLK high to output high impedance 28 ns
Valid
PCLK
5
PCI Output
PCI Input
3
Valid
2
6
1
4
Figure 49. PCI Input/Output Timing
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
118 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
timing requirements for serial EEPROM interface (see Figure 50)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
8 tsu(DIV-CLKH) Setup time, XSP_DI valid before XSP_CLK high 50 ns
9 th(CLKH-DIV) Hold time, XSP_DI valid after XSP_CLK high 0 ns
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for serial EEPROM interface
(see Figure 50)
NO. PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN TYP MAX
1 tw(CSL) Pulse duration, XSP_CS low 4092P ns
2 td(CLKL-CSL) Delay time, XSP_CLK low to XSP_CS low 0 ns
3 td(CSH-CLKH) Delay time, XSP_CS high to XSP_CLK high 2046P ns
4 tw(CLKH) Pulse duration, XSP_CLK high 2046P ns
5 tw(CLKL) Pulse duration, XSP_CLK low 2046P ns
6 tosu(DOV-CLKH) Output setup time, XSP_DO valid before XSP_CLK high 2046P ns
7 toh(CLKH-DOV) Output hold time, XSP_DO valid after XSP_CLK high 2046P ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
8
7
6
3
2
5
4
1
XSP_CS
XSP_CLK
XSP_DO
XSP_DI
9
Figure 50. PCI Serial EEPROM Interface Timing
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
119
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
MULTICHANNEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT (McBSP) TIMING
timing requirements for McBSP (see Figure 51)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
2 tc(CKRX) Cycle time, CLKR/X CLKR/X ext 4P or 6.67द ns
3 tw(CKRX) Pulse duration, CLKR/X high or CLKR/X low CLKR/X ext 0.5tc(CKRX) − 1#ns
5
tsu(FRH-CKRL)
Setup time, external FSR high before CLKR low
CLKR int 9
ns
5 tsu(FRH-CKRL) Setup time, external FSR high before CLKR low CLKR ext 1.3 ns
6
th(CKRL-FRH)
Hold time, external FSR high after CLKR low
CLKR int 6
ns
6 th(CKRL-FRH) Hold time, external FSR high after CLKR low CLKR ext 3ns
7
tsu(DRV-CKRL)
Setup time, DR valid before CLKR low
CLKR int 8
ns
7 tsu(DRV-CKRL) Setup time, DR valid before CLKR low CLKR ext 0.9 ns
8
th(CKRL-DRV)
Hold time, DR valid after CLKR low
CLKR int 3
ns
8 th(CKRL-DRV) Hold time, DR valid after CLKR low CLKR ext 3.1 ns
10
tsu(FXH-CKXL)
Setup time, external FSX high before CLKX low
CLKX int 9
ns
10 tsu(FXH-CKXL) Setup time, external FSX high before CLKX low CLKX ext 1.3 ns
11
th(CKXL-FXH)
Hold time, external FSX high after CLKX low
CLKX int 6
ns
11 th(CKXL-FXH) Hold time, external FSX high after CLKX low CLKX ext 3ns
CLKRP = CLKXP = FSRP = FSXP = 0. If polarity of any of the signals is inverted, then the timing references of that signal are also inverted.
Minimum CLKR/X cycle times must be met, even when CLKR/X is generated by an internal clock source. Minimum CLKR/X cycle times are based
on internal logic speed; the maximum usable speed may be lower due to EDMA limitations and AC timing requirements.
§P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
Use whichever value is greater.
#This parameter applies to the maximum McBSP frequency. Operate serial clocks (CLKR/X) in the reasonable range of 40/60 duty cycle.
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
120 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
MULTICHANNEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT (McBSP) TIMING (CONTINUED)
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for McBSP†‡ (see Figure 51)
NO. PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 td(CKSH-CKRXH) Delay time, CLKS high to CLKR/X high for internal CLKR/X generated
from CLKS input 1.4 10 ns
2 tc(CKRX) Cycle time, CLKR/X CLKR/X int 4P or 6.67§¶# ns
3 tw(CKRX) Pulse duration, CLKR/X high or CLKR/X low CLKR/X int C − 1|| C + 1|| ns
4 td(CKRH-FRV) Delay time, CLKR high to internal FSR valid CLKR int −2.1 3 ns
9
td(CKXH-FXV)
Delay time, CLKX high to internal FSX valid
CLKX int −1.7 3
ns
9 td(CKXH-FXV) Delay time, CLKX high to internal FSX valid CLKX ext 1.7 9 ns
12
tdis(CKXH-DXHZ)
Disable time, DX high impedance following last data bit
CLKX int −3.9 4
ns
12 tdis(CKXH-DXHZ)
Disable time, DX high impedance following last data bit
from CLKX high CLKX ext 2.0 9 ns
13
td(CKXH-DXV)
Delay time, CLKX high to DX valid
CLKX int −3.9 + D14 + D2
ns
13 td(CKXH-DXV) Delay time, CLKX high to DX valid CLKX ext 2.0 + D19 + D2ns
14
td(FXH-DXV)
Delay time, FSX high to DX valid FSX int −2.3 + D15.6 + D2
ns
14 td(FXH-DXV) ONLY applies when in data
delay 0 (XDATDLY = 00b) mode FSX ext 1.9 + D19 + D2ns
CLKRP = CLKXP = FSRP = FSXP = 0. If polarity of any of the signals is inverted, then the timing references of that signal are also inverted.
Minimum delay times also represent minimum output hold times.
§Minimum CLKR/X cycle times must be met, even when CLKR/X is generated by an internal clock source. Minimum CLKR/X cycle times are based
on internal logic speed; the maximum usable speed may be lower due to EDMA limitations and AC timing requirements.
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
#Use whichever value is greater.
|| C = H or L
S = sample rate generator input clock = 4P if CLKSM = 1 (P = 1/CPU clock frequency)
= sample rate generator input clock = P_clks if CLKSM = 0 (P_clks = CLKS period)
H = CLKX high pulse width = (CLKGDV/2 + 1) * S if CLKGDV is even
= (CLKGDV + 1)/2 * S if CLKGDV is odd or zero
L = CLKX low pulse width = (CLKGDV/2) * S if CLKGDV is even
= (CLKGDV + 1)/2 * S if CLKGDV is odd or zero
CLKGDV should be set appropriately to ensure the McBSP bit rate does not exceed the maximum limit (see ¶ footnote above).
Extra delay from CLKX high to DX valid applies only to the first data bit of a device, if and only if DXENA = 1 in SPCR.
if DXENA = 0, then D1 = D2 = 0
if DXENA = 1, then D1 = 4P, D2 = 8P
Extra delay from FSX high to DX valid applies only to the first data bit of a device, if and only if DXENA = 1 in SPCR.
if DXENA = 0, then D1 = D2 = 0
if DXENA = 1, then D1 = 4P, D2 = 8P
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
121
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
MULTICHANNEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT (McBSP) TIMING (CONTINUED)
Bit(n-1) (n-2) (n-3)
Bit 0 Bit(n-1) (n-2) (n-3)
14
12
11
10
9
3
32
8
7
6
5
4
4
3
1
32
CLKS
CLKR
FSR (int)
FSR (ext)
DR
CLKX
FSX (int)
FSX (ext)
FSX (XDATDLY=00b)
DX
Parameter No. 13 applies to the first data bit only when XDATDLY 0
13
13
Figure 51. McBSP Timing
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
122 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
MULTICHANNEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT (McBSP) TIMING (CONTINUED)
timing requirements for FSR when GSYNC = 1 (see Figure 52)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tsu(FRH-CKSH) Setup time, FSR high before CLKS high 4 ns
2 th(CKSH-FRH) Hold time, FSR high after CLKS high 4 ns
2
1
CLKS
FSR external
CLKR/X (no need to resync)
CLKR/X (needs resync)
Figure 52. FSR Timing When GSYNC = 1
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
123
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
MULTICHANNEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT (McBSP) TIMING (CONTINUED)
timing requirements for McBSP as SPI Master or Slave: CLKSTP = 10b, CLKXP = 0†‡ (see Figure 53)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3
UNIT
NO.
MASTER SLAVE
UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
4 tsu(DRV-CKXL) Setup time, DR valid before CLKX low 12 2 − 12P ns
5 th(CKXL-DRV) Hold time, DR valid after CLKX low 45 + 24P ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
For all SPI Slave modes, CLKG is programmed as 1/4 of the CPU clock by setting CLKSM = CLKGDV = 1.
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for McBSP as SPI Master or
Slave: CLKSTP = 10b, CLKXP = 0†‡ (see Figure 53)
NO.
PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3
UNIT
NO.
PARAMETER
MASTER§SLAVE
UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
1 th(CKXL-FXL) Hold time, FSX low after CLKX lowT − 2 T + 3 ns
2 td(FXL-CKXH) Delay time, FSX low to CLKX high#L − 2 L + 3 ns
3 td(CKXH-DXV) Delay time, CLKX high to DX valid −2 4 12P + 2.8 20P + 17 ns
6 tdis(CKXL-DXHZ) Disable time, DX high impedance following last data bit from
CLKX low L − 2 L + 3 ns
7 tdis(FXH-DXHZ) Disable time, DX high impedance following last data bit from
FSX high 4P + 3 12P + 17 ns
8 td(FXL-DXV) Delay time, FSX low to DX valid 8P + 1.8 16P + 17 ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
For all SPI Slave modes, CLKG is programmed as 1/4 of the CPU clock by setting CLKSM = CLKGDV = 1.
§S = Sample rate generator input clock = 4P if CLKSM = 1 (P = 1/CPU clock frequency)
= Sample rate generator input clock = P_clks if CLKSM = 0 (P_clks = CLKS period)
T = CLKX period = (1 + CLKGDV) * S
H = CLKX high pulse width = (CLKGDV/2 + 1) * S if CLKGDV is even
= (CLKGDV + 1)/2 * S if CLKGDV is odd or zero
L = CLKX low pulse width = (CLKGDV/2) * S if CLKGDV is even
= (CLKGDV + 1)/2 * S if CLKGDV is odd or zero
FSRP = FSXP = 1. As a SPI Master, FSX is inverted to provide active-low slave-enable output. As a Slave, the active-low signal input on FSX
and FSR is inverted before being used internally.
CLKXM = FSXM = 1, CLKRM = FSRM = 0 for Master McBSP
CLKXM = CLKRM = FSXM = FSRM = 0 for Slave McBSP
#FSX should be low before the rising edge of clock to enable Slave devices and then begin a SPI transfer at the rising edge of the Master clock
(CLKX).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
124 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
MULTICHANNEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT (McBSP) TIMING (CONTINUED)
Bit 0 Bit(n-1) (n-2) (n-3) (n-4)
Bit 0 Bit(n-1) (n-2) (n-3) (n-4)
5
4
3
87
6
21
CLKX
FSX
DX
DR
Figure 53. McBSP Timing as SPI Master or Slave: CLKSTP = 10b, CLKXP = 0
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
125
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
MULTICHANNEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT (McBSP) TIMING (CONTINUED)
timing requirements for McBSP as SPI Master or Slave: CLKSTP = 11b, CLKXP = 0†‡ (see Figure 54)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3
UNIT
NO.
MASTER SLAVE
UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
4 tsu(DRV-CKXH) Setup time, DR valid before CLKX high 12 2 − 12P ns
5 th(CKXH-DRV) Hold time, DR valid after CLKX high 45 + 24P ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
For all SPI Slave modes, CLKG is programmed as 1/4 of the CPU clock by setting CLKSM = CLKGDV = 1.
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for McBSP as SPI Master or
Slave: CLKSTP = 11b, CLKXP = 0†‡ (see Figure 54)
NO.
PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3
UNIT
NO.
PARAMETER
MASTER§SLAVE
UNIT
MIN MAX MIN MAX
1 th(CKXL-FXL) Hold time, FSX low after CLKX lowL − 2 L + 3 ns
2 td(FXL-CKXH) Delay time, FSX low to CLKX high#T − 2 T + 3 ns
3 td(CKXL-DXV) Delay time, CLKX low to DX valid −2 4 12P + 4 20P + 17 ns
6 tdis(CKXL-DXHZ) Disable time, DX high impedance following last data bit from
CLKX low −2 4 12P + 3 20P + 17 ns
7 td(FXL-DXV) Delay time, FSX low to DX valid H − 2 H + 4 8P + 2 16P + 17 ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
For all SPI Slave modes, CLKG is programmed as 1/4 of the CPU clock by setting CLKSM = CLKGDV = 1.
§S = Sample rate generator input clock = 4P if CLKSM = 1 (P = 1/CPU clock frequency)
= Sample rate generator input clock = P_clks if CLKSM = 0 (P_clks = CLKS period)
T = CLKX period = (1 + CLKGDV) * S
H = CLKX high pulse width = (CLKGDV/2 + 1) * S if CLKGDV is even
= (CLKGDV + 1)/2 * S if CLKGDV is odd or zero
L = CLKX low pulse width = (CLKGDV/2) * S if CLKGDV is even
= (CLKGDV + 1)/2 * S if CLKGDV is odd or zero
FSRP = FSXP = 1. As a SPI Master, FSX is inverted to provide active-low slave-enable output. As a Slave, the active-low signal input on FSX
and FSR is inverted before being used internally.
CLKXM = FSXM = 1, CLKRM = FSRM = 0 for Master McBSP
CLKXM = CLKRM = FSXM = FSRM = 0 for Slave McBSP
#FSX should be low before the rising edge of clock to enable Slave devices and then begin a SPI transfer at the rising edge of the Master clock
(CLKX).
Bit 0 Bit(n-1) (n-2) (n-3) (n-4)
Bit 0 Bit(n-1) (n-2) (n-3) (n-4)
4
376
21
CLKX
FSX
DX
DR 5
Figure 54. McBSP Timing as SPI Master or Slave: CLKSTP = 11b, CLKXP = 0
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
126 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
MULTICHANNEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT (McBSP) TIMING (CONTINUED)
timing requirements for McBSP as SPI Master or Slave: CLKSTP = 10b, CLKXP = 1†‡ (see Figure 55)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3
NO.
MASTER SLAVE
MIN MAX MIN MAX
4 tsu(DRV-CKXH) Setup time, DR valid before CLKX high 12 2 − 12P ns
5 th(CKXH-DRV) Hold time, DR valid after CLKX high 45 + 24P ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
For all SPI Slave modes, CLKG is programmed as 1/4 of the CPU clock by setting CLKSM = CLKGDV = 1.
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for McBSP as SPI Master or
Slave: CLKSTP = 10b, CLKXP = 1†‡ (see Figure 55)
NO.
PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3
NO.
PARAMETER
MASTER§SLAVE
MIN MAX MIN MAX
1 th(CKXH-FXL) Hold time, FSX low after CLKX highT − 2 T + 3 ns
2 td(FXL-CKXL) Delay time, FSX low to CLKX low#H − 2 H + 3 ns
3 td(CKXL-DXV) Delay time, CLKX low to DX valid −2 4 12P + 4 20P + 17 ns
6 tdis(CKXH-DXHZ) Disable time, DX high impedance following last data bit from
CLKX high H − 2 H + 3 ns
7 tdis(FXH-DXHZ) Disable time, DX high impedance following last data bit from
FSX high 4P + 3 12P + 17 ns
8 td(FXL-DXV) Delay time, FSX low to DX valid 8P + 2 16P + 17 ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
For all SPI Slave modes, CLKG is programmed as 1/4 of the CPU clock by setting CLKSM = CLKGDV = 1.
§S = Sample rate generator input clock = 4P if CLKSM = 1 (P = 1/CPU clock frequency)
= Sample rate generator input clock = P_clks if CLKSM = 0 (P_clks = CLKS period)
T = CLKX period = (1 + CLKGDV) * S
H = CLKX high pulse width = (CLKGDV/2 + 1) * S if CLKGDV is even
= (CLKGDV + 1)/2 * S if CLKGDV is odd or zero
L = CLKX low pulse width = (CLKGDV/2) * S if CLKGDV is even
= (CLKGDV + 1)/2 * S if CLKGDV is odd or zero
FSRP = FSXP = 1. As a SPI Master, FSX is inverted to provide active-low slave-enable output. As a Slave, the active-low signal input on FSX
and FSR is inverted before being used internally.
CLKXM = FSXM = 1, CLKRM = FSRM = 0 for Master McBSP
CLKXM = CLKRM = FSXM = FSRM = 0 for Slave McBSP
#FSX should be low before the rising edge of clock to enable Slave devices and then begin a SPI transfer at the rising edge of the Master clock
(CLKX).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
127
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
MULTICHANNEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT (McBSP) TIMING (CONTINUED)
Bit 0 Bit(n-1) (n-2) (n-3) (n-4)
Bit 0 Bit(n-1) (n-2) (n-3) (n-4)
5
4
38
7
6
21
CLKX
FSX
DX
DR
Figure 55. McBSP Timing as SPI Master or Slave: CLKSTP = 10b, CLKXP = 1
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
128 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
MULTICHANNEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT (McBSP) TIMING (CONTINUED)
timing requirements for McBSP as SPI Master or Slave: CLKSTP = 11b, CLKXP = 1†‡ (see Figure 56)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3
NO.
MASTER SLAVE
MIN MAX MIN MAX
4 tsu(DRV-CKXH) Setup time, DR valid before CLKX high 12 2 − 12P ns
5 th(CKXH-DRV) Hold time, DR valid after CLKX high 45 + 24P ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
For all SPI Slave modes, CLKG is programmed as 1/4 of the CPU clock by setting CLKSM = CLKGDV = 1.
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for McBSP as SPI Master or
Slave: CLKSTP = 11b, CLKXP = 1†‡ (see Figure 56)
NO.
PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3
NO.
PARAMETER
MASTER§SLAVE
MIN MAX MIN MAX
1 th(CKXH-FXL) Hold time, FSX low after CLKX highH − 2 H + 3 ns
2 td(FXL-CKXL) Delay time, FSX low to CLKX low#T − 2 T + 1 ns
3 td(CKXH-DXV) Delay time, CLKX high to DX valid −2 4 12P + 4 20P + 17 ns
6 tdis(CKXH-DXHZ) Disable time, DX high impedance following last data bit from
CLKX high −2 4 12P + 3 20P + 17 ns
7 td(FXL-DXV) Delay time, FSX low to DX valid L − 2 L + 4 8P + 2 16P + 17 ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
For all SPI Slave modes, CLKG is programmed as 1/4 of the CPU clock by setting CLKSM = CLKGDV = 1.
§S = Sample rate generator input clock = 4P if CLKSM = 1 (P = 1/CPU clock frequency)
= Sample rate generator input clock = P_clks if CLKSM = 0 (P_clks = CLKS period)
T = CLKX period = (1 + CLKGDV) * S
H = CLKX high pulse width = (CLKGDV/2 + 1) * S if CLKGDV is even
= (CLKGDV + 1)/2 * S if CLKGDV is odd or zero
L = CLKX low pulse width = (CLKGDV/2) * S if CLKGDV is even
= (CLKGDV + 1)/2 * S if CLKGDV is odd or zero
FSRP = FSXP = 1. As a SPI Master, FSX is inverted to provide active-low slave-enable output. As a Slave, the active-low signal input on FSX
and FSR is inverted before being used internally.
CLKXM = FSXM = 1, CLKRM = FSRM = 0 for Master McBSP
CLKXM = CLKRM = FSXM = FSRM = 0 for Slave McBSP
#FSX should be low before the rising edge of clock to enable Slave devices and then begin a SPI transfer at the rising edge of the Master clock
(CLKX).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
129
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
MULTICHANNEL BUFFERED SERIAL PORT (McBSP) TIMING (CONTINUED)
Bit 0 Bit(n-1) (n-2) (n-3) (n-4)
Bit 0 Bit(n-1) (n-2) (n-3) (n-4)
5
4
3
7
6
21
CLKX
FSX
DX
DR
Figure 56. McBSP Timing as SPI Master or Slave: CLKSTP = 11b, CLKXP = 1
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
130 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
UTOPIA SLAVE TIMING [C6415 AND C6416 ONLY]
timing requirements for UXCLK (see Figure 57)
NO
.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tc(UXCK) Cycle time, UXCLK 20 ns
2 tw(UXCKH) Pulse duration, UXCLK high 0.4tc(UXCK) 0.6tc(UXCK) ns
3 tw(UXCKL) Pulse duration, UXCLK low 0.4tc(UXCK) 0.6tc(UXCK) ns
4 tt(UXCK) Transition time, UXCLK 2 ns
The reference points for the rise and fall transitions are measured at VIL MAX and VIH MIN.
UXCLK
1
2
3
4
4
Figure 57. UXCLK Timing
timing requirements for URCLK (see Figure 58)
NO
.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tc(URCK) Cycle time, URCLK 20 ns
2 tw(URCKH) Pulse duration, URCLK high 0.4tc(URCK) 0.6tc(URCK) ns
3 tw(URCKL) Pulse duration, URCLK low 0.4tc(URCK) 0.6tc(URCK) ns
4 tt(URCK) Transition time, URCLK 2 ns
The reference points for the rise and fall transitions are measured at VIL MAX and VIH MIN.
URCLK
1
2
3
4
4
Figure 58. URCLK Timing
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
131
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
UTOPIA SLAVE TIMING [C6415 AND C6416 ONLY] (CONTINUED)
timing requirements for UTOPIA Slave transmit (see Figure 59)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
2 tsu(UXAV-UXCH) Setup time, UXADDR valid before UXCLK high 4 ns
3 th(UXCH-UXAV) Hold time, UXADDR valid after UXCLK high 1 ns
8 tsu(UXENBL-UXCH) Setup time, UXENB low before UXCLK high 4 ns
9 th(UXCH-UXENBL) Hold time, UXENB low after UXCLK high 1 ns
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for UTOPIA Slave transmit
(see Figure 59)
NO. PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 td(UXCH-UXDV) Delay time, UXCLK high to UXDATA valid 3 12 ns
4 td(UXCH-UXCLAV) Delay time, UXCLK high to UXCLAV driven active value 3 12 ns
5 td(UXCH-UXCLAVL) Delay time, UXCLK high to UXCLAV driven inactive low 3 12 ns
6 td(UXCH-UXCLAVHZ) Delay time, UXCLK high to UXCLAV going Hi-Z 9 18.5 ns
7 tw(UXCLAVL-UXCLAVHZ) Pulse duration (low), UXCLAV low to UXCLAV Hi-Z 3 ns
10 td(UXCH-UXSV) Delay time, UXCLK high to UXSOC valid 3 12 ns
P47 P48 H1
N 0x1F N 0x1F N + 1 0x1F
N N
10
8
4
3
2
1
UXCLK
UXDATA[7:0]
UXADDR[4:0]
UXCLAV
UXENB
UXSOC
9
P46P45
0 x1F
The UTOPIA Slave module has signals that are middle-level signals indicating a high-impedance state (i.e., the UXCLAV and
UXSOC signals).
5
67
Figure 59. UTOPIA Slave Transmit Timing
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
132 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
UTOPIA SLAVE TIMING [C6415 AND C6416 ONLY] (CONTINUED)
timing requirements for UTOPIA Slave receive (see Figure 60)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tsu(URDV-URCH) Setup time, URDATA valid before URCLK high 4 ns
2 th(URCH-URDV) Hold time, URDATA valid after URCLK high 1 ns
3 tsu(URAV-URCH) Setup time, URADDR valid before URCLK high 4 ns
4 th(URCH-URAV) Hold time, URADDR valid after URCLK high 1 ns
9 tsu(URENBL-URCH) Setup time, URENB low before URCLK high 4 ns
10 th(URCH-URENBL) Hold time, URENB low after URCLK high 1 ns
11 tsu(URSH-URCH) Setup time, URSOC high before URCLK high 4 ns
12 th(URCH-URSH) Hold time, URSOC high after URCLK high 1 ns
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for UTOPIA Slave receive
(see Figure 60)
NO. PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
5 td(URCH-URCLAV) Delay time, URCLK high to URCLAV driven active value 3 12 ns
6 td(URCH-URCLAVL) Delay time, URCLK high to URCLAV driven inactive low 3 12 ns
7 td(URCH-URCLAVHZ) Delay time, URCLK high to URCLAV going Hi-Z 9 18.5 ns
8 tw(URCLAVL-URCLAVHZ) Pulse duration (low), URCLAV low to URCLAV Hi-Z 3 ns
P48 H1 H2 H3
N 0x1F N+1 0x1F N+2 0x1F
N N+1 N+2
1211
9
10
5
4
3
2
1
URCLK
URDATA[7:0]
URADDR[4:0]
URCLAV
URENB
URSOC
The UTOPIA Slave module has signals that are middle-level signals indicating a high-impedance state (i.e., the URCLAV and
URSOC signals).
8
6
7
Figure 60. UTOPIA Slave Receive Timing
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
133
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
TIMER TIMING
timing requirements for timer inputs (see Figure 61)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tw(TINPH) Pulse duration, TINP high 8P ns
2 tw(TINPL) Pulse duration, TINP low 8P ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for timer outputs
(see Figure 61)
NO. PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
3 tw(TOUTH) Pulse duration, TOUT high 8P3 ns
4 tw(TOUTL) Pulse duration, TOUT low 8P3 ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
TINPx
TOUTx
4
3
2
1
Figure 61. Timer Timing
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
134 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
GENERAL-PURPOSE INPUT/OUTPUT (GPIO) PORT TIMING
timing requirements for GPIO inputs†‡ (see Figure 62)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tw(GPIH) Pulse duration, GPIx high 8P ns
2 tw(GPIL) Pulse duration, GPIx low 8P ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
The pulse width given is sufficient to generate a CPU interrupt or an EDMA event. However, if a user wants to have the DSP recognize the GPIx
changes through software polling of the GPIO register, the GPIx duration must be extended to at least 12P to allow the DSP enough time to access
the GPIO register through the CFGBUS.
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for GPIO outputs
(see Figure 62)
NO. PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
3 tw(GPOH) Pulse duration, GPOx high 24P − 8ns
4 tw(GPOL) Pulse duration, GPOx low 24P − 8ns
P = 1/CPU clock frequency in ns. For example, when running parts at 600 MHz, use P = 1.67 ns.
This parameter value should not be used as a maximum performance specification. Actual performance of back-to-back accesses of the GPIO
is dependent upon internal bus activity.
GPIx
GPOx
4
3
2
1
Figure 62. GPIO Port Timing
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
135
POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
JTAG TEST-PORT TIMING
timing requirements for JTAG test port (see Figure 63)
NO.
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
1 tc(TCK) Cycle time, TCK 35 ns
3 tsu(TDIV-TCKH) Setup time, TDI/TMS/TRST valid before TCK high 10 ns
4 th(TCKH-TDIV) Hold time, TDI/TMS/TRST valid after TCK high 9 ns
switching characteristics over recommended operating conditions for JTAG test port
(see Figure 63)
NO. PARAMETER
−5E0, A−5E0,
−6E3, A−6E3,
−7E3 UNIT
MIN MAX
2 td(TCKL-TDOV) Delay time, TCK low to TDO valid 0 18 ns
TCK
TDO
TDI/TMS/TRST
1
2
34
2
Figure 63. JTAG Test-Port Timing
ADVANCE INFORMATION
  
   
SPRS146L − FEBRUAR Y 2001 − REVISED JULY 2004
136 POST OFFICE BOX 1443 HOUSTON, TEXAS 77251−1443
MECHANICAL DATA
The following table(s) show the thermal resistance characteristics for the PBGA — GLZ and ZLZ mechanical
packages.
thermal resistance characteristics (S-PBGA package) [GLZ]
NO. Air Flow (m/s)°C/W °C/W
(with Heat Sink)
1 RΘJC Junction-to-case N/A 1.55 1.0
2 RΘJB Junction-to-board N/A 9.1 9.0
3 RΘJA Junction-to-free air 0.00 17.9 13.8
4 RΘJA Junction-to-free air 0.5 15.02 8.95
5 RΘJA Junction-to-free air 1.0 13.4 7.35
6 RΘJA Junction-to-free air 2.00 11.89 6.46
7 PsiJT Junction-to-package top N/A 0.5 0.5
8 PsiJB Junction-to-board N/A 7.4 7.4
m/s = meters per second
These thermal resistance numbers were modeled using a heat sink, part number 374024B00035, manufactured by AAVID Thermalloy. AAVID
Thermalloy also manufactures a similar epoxy-mounted heat sink, part number 374024B00000. When operating at 720 MHz, a heat sink should
be used to reduce the thermal resistance characteristics of the package. TI recommends a passive, laminar heat sink, similar to the part numbers
mentioned above.
thermal resistance characteristics (S-PBGA package) [ZLZ]
NO. Air Flow (m/s)°C/W °C/W
(with Heat Sink)
1 RΘJC Junction-to-case N/A 1.55 1.0
2 RΘJB Junction-to-board N/A 9.1 9.0
3 RΘJA Junction-to-free air 0.00 17.9 13.8
4 RΘJA Junction-to-free air 0.5 15.02 8.95
5 RΘJA Junction-to-free air 1.0 13.4 7.35
6 RΘJA Junction-to-free air 2.00 11.89 6.46
7 PsiJT Junction-to-package top N/A 0.5 0.5
8 PsiJB Junction-to-board N/A 7.4 7.4
m/s = meters per second
These thermal resistance numbers were modeled using a heat sink, part number 374024B00035, manufactured by AAVID Thermalloy. AAVID
Thermalloy also manufactures a similar epoxy-mounted heat sink, part number 374024B00000. When operating at 720 MHz, a heat sink should
be used to reduce the thermal resistance characteristics of the package. TI recommends a passive, laminar heat sink, similar to the part numbers
mentioned above.
The following mechanical package diagram(s) reflect the most up-to-date mechanical data released for these
designated device(s).
ADVANCE INFORMATION
 
MPBG175B − O C TOBER 2000 − REVISED FEBRUARY 2002
1
POST OFFICE BOX 655303 DALLAS, TEXAS 75265
GLZ (S-PBGA-N532) PLASTIC BALL GRID ARRAY
0,80
0,12
M
0,10
0,80
4201884/C 11/01
1,00 NOM
Seating Plane
0,55
0,45
A
20,00 TYP
0,35
0,45
22,90
23,10 SQ
2
B
3,30 MAX
Heat Slug
1 3 456789101112
1314
151617181920212223242526
C
DE
FG
HJ
KL
MN
PR
TU
VW
YAA
AB AC
AD AE
AF
0,40
0,40
Bottom View
A1 Corner
NOTES: A. All linear dimensions are in millimeters.
B. This drawing is subject to change without notice.
C. Thermally enhanced plastic package with heat slug (HSL)
D. Flip chip application only
IMPORTANT NOTICE
Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, modifications,
enhancements, improvements, and other changes to its products and services at any time and to discontinue
any product or service without notice. Customers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing
orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All products are sold subject to TI’ s terms
and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment.
TI warrants performance of its hardware products to the specifications applicable at the time of sale in
accordance with TI’s standard warranty. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI
deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by government requirements, testing of all
parameters of each product is not necessarily performed.
TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or customer product design. Customers are responsible for
their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with customer products
and applications, customers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards.
TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any TI patent right,
copyright, mask work right, or other TI intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process
in which TI products or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services
does not constitute a license from TI to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof.
Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property
of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI.
Reproduction of information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without
alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. Reproduction
of this information with alteration is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for
such altered documentation.
Resale of T I products or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that
product or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI product or service and
is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements.
Following are URLs where you can obtain information on other Texas Instruments products and application
solutions:
Products Applications
Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Audio www.ti.com/audio
Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Automotive www.ti.com/automotive
DSP dsp.ti.com Broadband www.ti.com/broadband
Interface interface.ti.com Digital Control www.ti.com/digitalcontrol
Logic logic.ti.com Military www.ti.com/military
Power Mgmt power.ti.com Optical Networking www.ti.com/opticalnetwork
Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security
Telephony www.ti.com/telephony
Video & Imaging www.ti.com/video
Wireless www.ti.com/wireless
Mailing Address: Texas Instruments
Post Office Box 655303 Dallas, Texas 75265
Copyright 2004, Texas Instruments Incorporated